2009-08-27 06:36:44 +08:00
|
|
|
/*===-- clang-c/Index.h - Indexing Public C Interface -------------*- C -*-===*\
|
|
|
|
|* *|
|
|
|
|
|* The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure *|
|
|
|
|
|* *|
|
|
|
|
|* This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source *|
|
|
|
|
|* License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. *|
|
|
|
|
|* *|
|
|
|
|
|*===----------------------------------------------------------------------===*|
|
|
|
|
|* *|
|
|
|
|
|* This header provides a public inferface to a Clang library for extracting *|
|
|
|
|
|* high-level symbol information from source files without exposing the full *|
|
|
|
|
|* Clang C++ API. *|
|
|
|
|
|* *|
|
|
|
|
\*===----------------------------------------------------------------------===*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef CLANG_C_INDEX_H
|
|
|
|
#define CLANG_C_INDEX_H
|
|
|
|
|
2009-10-27 22:35:18 +08:00
|
|
|
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
2009-12-17 17:27:29 +08:00
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
2009-10-27 22:35:18 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2012-06-29 06:01:06 +08:00
|
|
|
#include "clang-c/Platform.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "clang-c/CXString.h"
|
|
|
|
|
2009-08-27 06:36:44 +08:00
|
|
|
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
|
|
|
extern "C" {
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
2011-02-24 01:45:25 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \defgroup CINDEX libclang: C Interface to Clang
|
2010-01-20 09:10:47 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* The C Interface to Clang provides a relatively small API that exposes
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
* facilities for parsing source code into an abstract syntax tree (AST),
|
|
|
|
* loading already-parsed ASTs, traversing the AST, associating
|
|
|
|
* physical source locations with elements within the AST, and other
|
|
|
|
* facilities that support Clang-based development tools.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* This C interface to Clang will never provide all of the information
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
* representation stored in Clang's C++ AST, nor should it: the intent is to
|
|
|
|
* maintain an API that is relatively stable from one release to the next,
|
|
|
|
* providing only the basic functionality needed to support development tools.
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* To avoid namespace pollution, data types are prefixed with "CX" and
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
* functions are prefixed with "clang_".
|
2010-01-20 09:10:47 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:28:27 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An "index" that consists of a set of translation units that would
|
|
|
|
* typically be linked together into an executable or library.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void *CXIndex;
|
2009-08-28 03:51:58 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:28:27 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A single translation unit, which resides in an index.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-11-18 07:24:11 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct CXTranslationUnitImpl *CXTranslationUnit;
|
2009-08-28 03:51:58 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:28:27 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Opaque pointer representing client data that will be passed through
|
|
|
|
* to various callbacks and visitors.
|
2010-01-21 06:28:27 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef void *CXClientData;
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-12-02 17:21:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Provides the contents of a file that has not yet been saved to disk.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Each CXUnsavedFile instance provides the name of a file on the
|
|
|
|
* system along with the current contents of that file that have not
|
|
|
|
* yet been saved to disk.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
struct CXUnsavedFile {
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The file whose contents have not yet been saved.
|
2009-12-02 17:21:34 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This file must already exist in the file system.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
const char *Filename;
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-02-27 09:32:48 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief A buffer containing the unsaved contents of this file.
|
2009-12-02 17:21:34 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
const char *Contents;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-02-27 09:32:48 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief The length of the unsaved contents of this buffer.
|
2009-12-02 17:21:34 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
unsigned long Length;
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-24 08:31:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes the availability of a particular entity, which indicates
|
|
|
|
* whether the use of this entity will result in a warning or error due to
|
|
|
|
* it being deprecated or unavailable.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
enum CXAvailabilityKind {
|
2010-08-24 08:31:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The entity is available.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
CXAvailability_Available,
|
2010-08-24 08:31:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The entity is available, but has been deprecated (and its use is
|
|
|
|
* not recommended).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
CXAvailability_Deprecated,
|
2010-08-24 08:31:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The entity is not available; any use of it will be an error.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-06 15:27:49 +08:00
|
|
|
CXAvailability_NotAvailable,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The entity is available, but not accessible; any use of it will be
|
|
|
|
* an error.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXAvailability_NotAccessible
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
2012-05-08 08:14:45 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes a version number of the form major.minor.subminor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct CXVersion {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The major version number, e.g., the '10' in '10.7.3'. A negative
|
|
|
|
* value indicates that there is no version number at all.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int Major;
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The minor version number, e.g., the '7' in '10.7.3'. This value
|
|
|
|
* will be negative if no minor version number was provided, e.g., for
|
|
|
|
* version '10'.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int Minor;
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The subminor version number, e.g., the '3' in '10.7.3'. This value
|
|
|
|
* will be negative if no minor or subminor version number was provided,
|
|
|
|
* e.g., in version '10' or '10.7'.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int Subminor;
|
|
|
|
} CXVersion;
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Provides a shared context for creating translation units.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* It provides two options:
|
2009-10-20 22:46:24 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* - excludeDeclarationsFromPCH: When non-zero, allows enumeration of "local"
|
|
|
|
* declarations (when loading any new translation units). A "local" declaration
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* is one that belongs in the translation unit itself and not in a precompiled
|
2009-10-20 22:46:24 +08:00
|
|
|
* header that was used by the translation unit. If zero, all declarations
|
|
|
|
* will be enumerated.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2009-10-21 00:36:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* Here is an example:
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \code
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
* // excludeDeclsFromPCH = 1, displayDiagnostics=1
|
|
|
|
* Idx = clang_createIndex(1, 1);
|
2009-10-21 00:36:34 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* // IndexTest.pch was produced with the following command:
|
|
|
|
* // "clang -x c IndexTest.h -emit-ast -o IndexTest.pch"
|
|
|
|
* TU = clang_createTranslationUnit(Idx, "IndexTest.pch");
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* // This will load all the symbols from 'IndexTest.pch'
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* clang_visitChildren(clang_getTranslationUnitCursor(TU),
|
2010-01-21 05:37:00 +08:00
|
|
|
* TranslationUnitVisitor, 0);
|
2009-10-21 00:36:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* clang_disposeTranslationUnit(TU);
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* // This will load all the symbols from 'IndexTest.c', excluding symbols
|
|
|
|
* // from 'IndexTest.pch'.
|
2010-01-25 08:43:14 +08:00
|
|
|
* char *args[] = { "-Xclang", "-include-pch=IndexTest.pch" };
|
|
|
|
* TU = clang_createTranslationUnitFromSourceFile(Idx, "IndexTest.c", 2, args,
|
|
|
|
* 0, 0);
|
2010-01-21 07:57:43 +08:00
|
|
|
* clang_visitChildren(clang_getTranslationUnitCursor(TU),
|
|
|
|
* TranslationUnitVisitor, 0);
|
2009-10-21 00:36:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* clang_disposeTranslationUnit(TU);
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
2009-10-21 00:36:34 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This process of creating the 'pch', loading it separately, and using it (via
|
|
|
|
* -include-pch) allows 'excludeDeclsFromPCH' to remove redundant callbacks
|
|
|
|
* (which gives the indexer the same performance benefit as the compiler).
|
2009-10-20 22:46:24 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXIndex clang_createIndex(int excludeDeclarationsFromPCH,
|
|
|
|
int displayDiagnostics);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-02-09 07:03:06 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Destroy the given index.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The index must not be destroyed until all of the translation units created
|
|
|
|
* within that index have been destroyed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2009-12-03 09:54:28 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_disposeIndex(CXIndex index);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2012-03-28 10:18:05 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef enum {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that no special CXIndex options are needed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXGlobalOpt_None = 0x0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that threads that libclang creates for indexing
|
|
|
|
* purposes should use background priority.
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Affects #clang_indexSourceFile, #clang_indexTranslationUnit,
|
|
|
|
* #clang_parseTranslationUnit, #clang_saveTranslationUnit.
|
2012-03-28 10:18:05 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing = 0x1,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that threads that libclang creates for editing
|
|
|
|
* purposes should use background priority.
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Affects #clang_reparseTranslationUnit, #clang_codeCompleteAt,
|
|
|
|
* #clang_annotateTokens
|
2012-03-28 10:18:05 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForEditing = 0x2,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that all threads that libclang creates should use
|
|
|
|
* background priority.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForAll =
|
|
|
|
CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing |
|
|
|
|
CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForEditing
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
} CXGlobalOptFlags;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Sets general options associated with a CXIndex.
|
2012-03-28 10:18:05 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example:
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* CXIndex idx = ...;
|
|
|
|
* clang_CXIndex_setGlobalOptions(idx,
|
|
|
|
* clang_CXIndex_getGlobalOptions(idx) |
|
|
|
|
* CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing);
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param options A bitmask of options, a bitwise OR of CXGlobalOpt_XXX flags.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_CXIndex_setGlobalOptions(CXIndex, unsigned options);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Gets the general options associated with a CXIndex.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns A bitmask of options, a bitwise OR of CXGlobalOpt_XXX flags that
|
|
|
|
* are associated with the given CXIndex object.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_CXIndex_getGlobalOptions(CXIndex);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_FILES File manipulation routines
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A particular source file that is part of a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void *CXFile;
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the complete file and path name of the given file.
|
2009-10-27 22:35:18 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-02-17 08:41:20 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getFileName(CXFile SFile);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the last modification time of the given file.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2009-10-31 23:48:08 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE time_t clang_getFileTime(CXFile SFile);
|
2009-10-27 22:35:18 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-05-04 08:14:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given header is guarded against
|
|
|
|
* multiple inclusions, either with the conventional
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \#ifndef/\#define/\#endif macro guards or with \#pragma once.
|
2011-05-04 08:14:37 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned
|
|
|
|
clang_isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(CXTranslationUnit tu, CXFile file);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a file handle within the given translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param tu the translation unit
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param file_name the name of the file.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the file handle for the named file in the translation unit \p tu,
|
|
|
|
* or a NULL file handle if the file was not a part of this translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXFile clang_getFile(CXTranslationUnit tu,
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
const char *file_name);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_LOCATIONS Physical source locations
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Clang represents physical source locations in its abstract syntax tree in
|
|
|
|
* great detail, with file, line, and column information for the majority of
|
|
|
|
* the tokens parsed in the source code. These data types and functions are
|
|
|
|
* used to represent source location information, either for a particular
|
|
|
|
* point in the program or for a range of points in the program, and extract
|
|
|
|
* specific location information from those data types.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-19 06:13:09 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Identifies a specific source location within a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2011-09-01 00:53:37 +08:00
|
|
|
* Use clang_getExpansionLocation() or clang_getSpellingLocation()
|
2010-11-09 14:24:54 +08:00
|
|
|
* to map a source location to a particular file, line, and column.
|
2010-01-19 06:13:09 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
void *ptr_data[2];
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned int_data;
|
2010-01-19 06:13:09 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXSourceLocation;
|
2010-01-06 07:18:49 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-19 06:13:09 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-02-14 18:02:57 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Identifies a half-open character range in the source code.
|
2010-01-19 06:13:09 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
* Use clang_getRangeStart() and clang_getRangeEnd() to retrieve the
|
|
|
|
* starting and end locations from a source range, respectively.
|
2010-01-19 06:13:09 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
void *ptr_data[2];
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned begin_int_data;
|
|
|
|
unsigned end_int_data;
|
2010-01-19 06:13:09 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXSourceRange;
|
2010-01-06 07:18:49 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a NULL (invalid) source location.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceLocation clang_getNullLocation();
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether two source locations, which must refer into
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* the same translation unit, refer to exactly the same point in the source
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
* code.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if the source locations refer to the same location, zero
|
|
|
|
* if they refer to different locations.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_equalLocations(CXSourceLocation loc1,
|
|
|
|
CXSourceLocation loc2);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieves the source location associated with a given file/line/column
|
|
|
|
* in a particular translation unit.
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceLocation clang_getLocation(CXTranslationUnit tu,
|
|
|
|
CXFile file,
|
|
|
|
unsigned line,
|
|
|
|
unsigned column);
|
2010-10-16 01:07:39 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieves the source location associated with a given character offset
|
|
|
|
* in a particular translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceLocation clang_getLocationForOffset(CXTranslationUnit tu,
|
|
|
|
CXFile file,
|
|
|
|
unsigned offset);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a NULL (invalid) source range.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceRange clang_getNullRange();
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a source range given the beginning and ending source
|
|
|
|
* locations.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceRange clang_getRange(CXSourceLocation begin,
|
|
|
|
CXSourceLocation end);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-07-24 03:35:14 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether two ranges are equivalent.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if the ranges are the same, zero if they differ.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_equalRanges(CXSourceRange range1,
|
|
|
|
CXSourceRange range2);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-09-29 02:14:21 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns non-zero if \arg range is null.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-06 20:11:57 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_Range_isNull(CXSourceRange range);
|
2011-09-29 02:14:21 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-27 03:19:08 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the file, line, column, and offset represented by
|
|
|
|
* the given source location.
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2011-09-01 00:53:37 +08:00
|
|
|
* If the location refers into a macro expansion, retrieves the
|
|
|
|
* location of the macro expansion.
|
2010-11-09 14:24:54 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param location the location within a source file that will be decomposed
|
|
|
|
* into its parts.
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param file [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the file to which the given
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
* source location points.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param line [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the line to which the given
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
* source location points.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param column [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the column to which the given
|
|
|
|
* source location points.
|
2010-01-27 03:19:08 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param offset [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the offset into the
|
|
|
|
* buffer to which the given source location points.
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-09-01 00:53:37 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_getExpansionLocation(CXSourceLocation location,
|
|
|
|
CXFile *file,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *line,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *column,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *offset);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-09-14 05:49:08 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the file, line, column, and offset represented by
|
|
|
|
* the given source location, as specified in a # line directive.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Example: given the following source code in a file somefile.c
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \code
|
2011-09-14 05:49:08 +08:00
|
|
|
* #123 "dummy.c" 1
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* static int func(void)
|
|
|
|
* {
|
|
|
|
* return 0;
|
|
|
|
* }
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
2011-09-14 05:49:08 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* the location information returned by this function would be
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* File: dummy.c Line: 124 Column: 12
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* whereas clang_getExpansionLocation would have returned
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* File: somefile.c Line: 3 Column: 12
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param location the location within a source file that will be decomposed
|
|
|
|
* into its parts.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param filename [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the filename of the
|
|
|
|
* source location. Note that filenames returned will be for "virtual" files,
|
|
|
|
* which don't necessarily exist on the machine running clang - e.g. when
|
|
|
|
* parsing preprocessed output obtained from a different environment. If
|
|
|
|
* a non-NULL value is passed in, remember to dispose of the returned value
|
|
|
|
* using \c clang_disposeString() once you've finished with it. For an invalid
|
|
|
|
* source location, an empty string is returned.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param line [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the line number of the
|
|
|
|
* source location. For an invalid source location, zero is returned.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param column [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the column number of the
|
|
|
|
* source location. For an invalid source location, zero is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_getPresumedLocation(CXSourceLocation location,
|
|
|
|
CXString *filename,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *line,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *column);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-09-01 00:53:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Legacy API to retrieve the file, line, column, and offset represented
|
|
|
|
* by the given source location.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This interface has been replaced by the newer interface
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* #clang_getExpansionLocation(). See that interface's documentation for
|
2011-09-01 00:53:37 +08:00
|
|
|
* details.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_getInstantiationLocation(CXSourceLocation location,
|
|
|
|
CXFile *file,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *line,
|
2010-01-27 03:19:08 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned *column,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *offset);
|
2010-01-26 11:07:15 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-11-09 14:24:54 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the file, line, column, and offset represented by
|
|
|
|
* the given source location.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If the location refers into a macro instantiation, return where the
|
|
|
|
* location was originally spelled in the source file.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param location the location within a source file that will be decomposed
|
|
|
|
* into its parts.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param file [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the file to which the given
|
|
|
|
* source location points.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param line [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the line to which the given
|
|
|
|
* source location points.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param column [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the column to which the given
|
|
|
|
* source location points.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param offset [out] if non-NULL, will be set to the offset into the
|
|
|
|
* buffer to which the given source location points.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_getSpellingLocation(CXSourceLocation location,
|
|
|
|
CXFile *file,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *line,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *column,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *offset);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a source location representing the first character within a
|
|
|
|
* source range.
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceLocation clang_getRangeStart(CXSourceRange range);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a source location representing the last character within a
|
|
|
|
* source range.
|
2010-01-20 05:36:55 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceLocation clang_getRangeEnd(CXSourceRange range);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_DIAG Diagnostic reporting
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes the severity of a particular diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXDiagnosticSeverity {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief A diagnostic that has been suppressed, e.g., by a command-line
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
* option.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_Ignored = 0,
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief This diagnostic is a note that should be attached to the
|
|
|
|
* previous (non-note) diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_Note = 1,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief This diagnostic indicates suspicious code that may not be
|
|
|
|
* wrong.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_Warning = 2,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief This diagnostic indicates that the code is ill-formed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_Error = 3,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief This diagnostic indicates that the code is ill-formed such
|
|
|
|
* that future parser recovery is unlikely to produce useful
|
|
|
|
* results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_Fatal = 4
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A single diagnostic, containing the diagnostic's severity,
|
|
|
|
* location, text, source ranges, and fix-it hints.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void *CXDiagnostic;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-10 16:43:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A group of CXDiagnostics.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void *CXDiagnosticSet;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the number of diagnostics in a CXDiagnosticSet.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_getNumDiagnosticsInSet(CXDiagnosticSet Diags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a diagnostic associated with the given CXDiagnosticSet.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Diags the CXDiagnosticSet to query.
|
2011-11-10 16:43:12 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Index the zero-based diagnostic number to retrieve.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the requested diagnostic. This diagnostic must be freed
|
|
|
|
* via a call to \c clang_disposeDiagnostic().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXDiagnostic clang_getDiagnosticInSet(CXDiagnosticSet Diags,
|
|
|
|
unsigned Index);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes the kind of error that occurred (if any) in a call to
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_loadDiagnostics.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXLoadDiag_Error {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Indicates that no error occurred.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXLoadDiag_None = 0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Indicates that an unknown error occurred while attempting to
|
|
|
|
* deserialize diagnostics.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXLoadDiag_Unknown = 1,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Indicates that the file containing the serialized diagnostics
|
|
|
|
* could not be opened.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXLoadDiag_CannotLoad = 2,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Indicates that the serialized diagnostics file is invalid or
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* corrupt.
|
2011-11-10 16:43:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXLoadDiag_InvalidFile = 3
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Deserialize a set of diagnostics from a Clang diagnostics bitcode
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* file.
|
2011-11-10 16:43:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param file The name of the file to deserialize.
|
|
|
|
* \param error A pointer to a enum value recording if there was a problem
|
2011-11-10 16:43:12 +08:00
|
|
|
* deserializing the diagnostics.
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param errorString A pointer to a CXString for recording the error string
|
2011-11-10 16:43:12 +08:00
|
|
|
* if the file was not successfully loaded.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns A loaded CXDiagnosticSet if successful, and NULL otherwise. These
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* diagnostics should be released using clang_disposeDiagnosticSet().
|
2011-11-10 16:43:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXDiagnosticSet clang_loadDiagnostics(const char *file,
|
|
|
|
enum CXLoadDiag_Error *error,
|
|
|
|
CXString *errorString);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Release a CXDiagnosticSet and all of its contained diagnostics.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_disposeDiagnosticSet(CXDiagnosticSet Diags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the child diagnostics of a CXDiagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This CXDiagnosticSet does not need to be released by
|
|
|
|
* clang_diposeDiagnosticSet.
|
2011-11-10 16:43:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXDiagnosticSet clang_getChildDiagnostics(CXDiagnostic D);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the number of diagnostics produced for the given
|
|
|
|
* translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_getNumDiagnostics(CXTranslationUnit Unit);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a diagnostic associated with the given translation unit.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Unit the translation unit to query.
|
|
|
|
* \param Index the zero-based diagnostic number to retrieve.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns the requested diagnostic. This diagnostic must be freed
|
|
|
|
* via a call to \c clang_disposeDiagnostic().
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXDiagnostic clang_getDiagnostic(CXTranslationUnit Unit,
|
|
|
|
unsigned Index);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-12-10 06:28:32 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the complete set of diagnostics associated with a
|
|
|
|
* translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Unit the translation unit to query.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXDiagnosticSet
|
|
|
|
clang_getDiagnosticSetFromTU(CXTranslationUnit Unit);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Destroy a diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_disposeDiagnostic(CXDiagnostic Diagnostic);
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Options to control the display of diagnostics.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The values in this enum are meant to be combined to customize the
|
|
|
|
* behavior of \c clang_displayDiagnostic().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXDiagnosticDisplayOptions {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Display the source-location information where the
|
|
|
|
* diagnostic was located.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* When set, diagnostics will be prefixed by the file, line, and
|
|
|
|
* (optionally) column to which the diagnostic refers. For example,
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* test.c:28: warning: extra tokens at end of #endif directive
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This option corresponds to the clang flag \c -fshow-source-location.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_DisplaySourceLocation = 0x01,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief If displaying the source-location information of the
|
|
|
|
* diagnostic, also include the column number.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This option corresponds to the clang flag \c -fshow-column.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_DisplayColumn = 0x02,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief If displaying the source-location information of the
|
|
|
|
* diagnostic, also include information about source ranges in a
|
|
|
|
* machine-parsable format.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* This option corresponds to the clang flag
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
* \c -fdiagnostics-print-source-range-info.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-11-20 00:18:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_DisplaySourceRanges = 0x04,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Display the option name associated with this diagnostic, if any.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The option name displayed (e.g., -Wconversion) will be placed in brackets
|
|
|
|
* after the diagnostic text. This option corresponds to the clang flag
|
|
|
|
* \c -fdiagnostics-show-option.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_DisplayOption = 0x08,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Display the category number associated with this diagnostic, if any.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The category number is displayed within brackets after the diagnostic text.
|
|
|
|
* This option corresponds to the clang flag
|
|
|
|
* \c -fdiagnostics-show-category=id.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_DisplayCategoryId = 0x10,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Display the category name associated with this diagnostic, if any.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The category name is displayed within brackets after the diagnostic text.
|
|
|
|
* This option corresponds to the clang flag
|
|
|
|
* \c -fdiagnostics-show-category=name.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic_DisplayCategoryName = 0x20
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-02-23 07:17:23 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Format the given diagnostic in a manner that is suitable for display.
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-23 07:17:23 +08:00
|
|
|
* This routine will format the given diagnostic to a string, rendering
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* the diagnostic according to the various options given. The
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_defaultDiagnosticDisplayOptions() function returns the set of
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
* options that most closely mimics the behavior of the clang compiler.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Diagnostic The diagnostic to print.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Options A set of options that control the diagnostic display,
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
* created by combining \c CXDiagnosticDisplayOptions values.
|
2010-02-23 07:17:23 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns A new string containing for formatted diagnostic.
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-02-23 07:17:23 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_formatDiagnostic(CXDiagnostic Diagnostic,
|
|
|
|
unsigned Options);
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the set of display options most similar to the
|
|
|
|
* default behavior of the clang compiler.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns A set of display options suitable for use with \c
|
|
|
|
* clang_displayDiagnostic().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_defaultDiagnosticDisplayOptions(void);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the severity of the given diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXDiagnosticSeverity
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
clang_getDiagnosticSeverity(CXDiagnostic);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the source location of the given diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This location is where Clang would print the caret ('^') when
|
|
|
|
* displaying the diagnostic on the command line.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceLocation clang_getDiagnosticLocation(CXDiagnostic);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the text of the given diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getDiagnosticSpelling(CXDiagnostic);
|
2010-02-09 07:11:56 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-11-20 00:18:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the name of the command-line option that enabled this
|
|
|
|
* diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Diag The diagnostic to be queried.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Disable If non-NULL, will be set to the option that disables this
|
|
|
|
* diagnostic (if any).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns A string that contains the command-line option used to enable this
|
|
|
|
* warning, such as "-Wconversion" or "-pedantic".
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getDiagnosticOption(CXDiagnostic Diag,
|
|
|
|
CXString *Disable);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the category number for this diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Diagnostics can be categorized into groups along with other, related
|
|
|
|
* diagnostics (e.g., diagnostics under the same warning flag). This routine
|
|
|
|
* retrieves the category number for the given diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The number of the category that contains this diagnostic, or zero
|
|
|
|
* if this diagnostic is uncategorized.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_getDiagnosticCategory(CXDiagnostic);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-04-12 08:03:31 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the name of a particular diagnostic category. This
|
|
|
|
* is now deprecated. Use clang_getDiagnosticCategoryText()
|
|
|
|
* instead.
|
2010-11-20 00:18:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Category A diagnostic category number, as returned by
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_getDiagnosticCategory().
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The name of the given diagnostic category.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-04-12 08:03:31 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_DEPRECATED CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_getDiagnosticCategoryName(unsigned Category);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the diagnostic category text for a given diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The text of the given diagnostic category.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getDiagnosticCategoryText(CXDiagnostic);
|
2010-11-20 00:18:16 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-02-09 07:11:56 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the number of source ranges associated with the given
|
|
|
|
* diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_getDiagnosticNumRanges(CXDiagnostic);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-02-09 07:11:56 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a source range associated with the diagnostic.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-09 07:11:56 +08:00
|
|
|
* A diagnostic's source ranges highlight important elements in the source
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
* code. On the command line, Clang displays source ranges by
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* underlining them with '~' characters.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-09 07:11:56 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Diagnostic the diagnostic whose range is being extracted.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Range the zero-based index specifying which range to
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-09 07:11:56 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns the requested source range.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceRange clang_getDiagnosticRange(CXDiagnostic Diagnostic,
|
2010-02-09 07:11:56 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned Range);
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the number of fix-it hints associated with the
|
|
|
|
* given diagnostic.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_getDiagnosticNumFixIts(CXDiagnostic Diagnostic);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-02-20 02:16:06 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the replacement information for a given fix-it.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-20 02:16:06 +08:00
|
|
|
* Fix-its are described in terms of a source range whose contents
|
|
|
|
* should be replaced by a string. This approach generalizes over
|
|
|
|
* three kinds of operations: removal of source code (the range covers
|
|
|
|
* the code to be removed and the replacement string is empty),
|
|
|
|
* replacement of source code (the range covers the code to be
|
|
|
|
* replaced and the replacement string provides the new code), and
|
|
|
|
* insertion (both the start and end of the range point at the
|
|
|
|
* insertion location, and the replacement string provides the text to
|
|
|
|
* insert).
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-20 02:16:06 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Diagnostic The diagnostic whose fix-its are being queried.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-20 02:16:06 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param FixIt The zero-based index of the fix-it.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-20 02:16:06 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param ReplacementRange The source range whose contents will be
|
|
|
|
* replaced with the returned replacement string. Note that source
|
|
|
|
* ranges are half-open ranges [a, b), so the source code should be
|
|
|
|
* replaced from a and up to (but not including) b.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-20 02:16:06 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns A string containing text that should be replace the source
|
|
|
|
* code indicated by the \c ReplacementRange.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getDiagnosticFixIt(CXDiagnostic Diagnostic,
|
2010-02-20 02:16:06 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned FixIt,
|
|
|
|
CXSourceRange *ReplacementRange);
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_TRANSLATION_UNIT Translation unit manipulation
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The routines in this group provide the ability to create and destroy
|
|
|
|
* translation units from files, either by parsing the contents of the files or
|
|
|
|
* by reading in a serialized representation of a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Get the original translation unit source file name.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString
|
|
|
|
clang_getTranslationUnitSpelling(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return the CXTranslationUnit for a given source file and the provided
|
|
|
|
* command line arguments one would pass to the compiler.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Note: The 'source_filename' argument is optional. If the caller provides a
|
|
|
|
* NULL pointer, the name of the source file is expected to reside in the
|
|
|
|
* specified command line arguments.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Note: When encountered in 'clang_command_line_args', the following options
|
|
|
|
* are ignored:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* '-c'
|
|
|
|
* '-emit-ast'
|
|
|
|
* '-fsyntax-only'
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* '-o \<output file>' (both '-o' and '\<output file>' are ignored)
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-11-08 12:28:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param CIdx The index object with which the translation unit will be
|
|
|
|
* associated.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param source_filename The name of the source file to load, or NULL if the
|
2010-11-08 12:28:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* source file is included in \p clang_command_line_args.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param num_clang_command_line_args The number of command-line arguments in
|
|
|
|
* \p clang_command_line_args.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param clang_command_line_args The command-line arguments that would be
|
|
|
|
* passed to the \c clang executable if it were being invoked out-of-process.
|
|
|
|
* These command-line options will be parsed and will affect how the translation
|
|
|
|
* unit is parsed. Note that the following options are ignored: '-c',
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* '-emit-ast', '-fsyntax-only' (which is the default), and '-o \<output file>'.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param num_unsaved_files the number of unsaved file entries in \p
|
|
|
|
* unsaved_files.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param unsaved_files the files that have not yet been saved to disk
|
|
|
|
* but may be required for code completion, including the contents of
|
2010-04-13 02:47:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* those files. The contents and name of these files (as specified by
|
|
|
|
* CXUnsavedFile) are copied when necessary, so the client only needs to
|
|
|
|
* guarantee their validity until the call to this function returns.
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXTranslationUnit clang_createTranslationUnitFromSourceFile(
|
|
|
|
CXIndex CIdx,
|
|
|
|
const char *source_filename,
|
|
|
|
int num_clang_command_line_args,
|
2010-09-02 00:43:19 +08:00
|
|
|
const char * const *clang_command_line_args,
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned num_unsaved_files,
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Create a translation unit from an AST file (-emit-ast).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXTranslationUnit clang_createTranslationUnit(CXIndex,
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
const char *ast_filename);
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-07-23 08:33:23 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Flags that control the creation of translation units.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The enumerators in this enumeration type are meant to be bitwise
|
|
|
|
* ORed together to specify which options should be used when
|
|
|
|
* constructing the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-07-22 02:52:53 +08:00
|
|
|
enum CXTranslationUnit_Flags {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that no special translation-unit options are
|
|
|
|
* needed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_None = 0x0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that the parser should construct a "detailed"
|
|
|
|
* preprocessing record, including all macro definitions and instantiations.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Constructing a detailed preprocessing record requires more memory
|
|
|
|
* and time to parse, since the information contained in the record
|
|
|
|
* is usually not retained. However, it can be useful for
|
|
|
|
* applications that require more detailed information about the
|
|
|
|
* behavior of the preprocessor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-07-23 08:33:23 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_DetailedPreprocessingRecord = 0x01,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-08-10 06:28:58 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that the translation unit is incomplete.
|
2010-07-23 08:33:23 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-08-10 06:28:58 +08:00
|
|
|
* When a translation unit is considered "incomplete", semantic
|
|
|
|
* analysis that is typically performed at the end of the
|
|
|
|
* translation unit will be suppressed. For example, this suppresses
|
|
|
|
* the completion of tentative declarations in C and of
|
|
|
|
* instantiation of implicitly-instantiation function templates in
|
|
|
|
* C++. This option is typically used when parsing a header with the
|
|
|
|
* intent of producing a precompiled header.
|
2010-07-23 08:33:23 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-08-10 06:28:58 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_Incomplete = 0x02,
|
2010-07-23 08:33:23 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that the translation unit should be built with an
|
|
|
|
* implicit precompiled header for the preamble.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* An implicit precompiled header is used as an optimization when a
|
|
|
|
* particular translation unit is likely to be reparsed many times
|
|
|
|
* when the sources aren't changing that often. In this case, an
|
|
|
|
* implicit precompiled header will be built containing all of the
|
|
|
|
* initial includes at the top of the main file (what we refer to as
|
|
|
|
* the "preamble" of the file). In subsequent parses, if the
|
|
|
|
* preamble or the files in it have not changed, \c
|
|
|
|
* clang_reparseTranslationUnit() will re-use the implicit
|
|
|
|
* precompiled header to improve parsing performance.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-08-11 23:58:42 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_PrecompiledPreamble = 0x04,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that the translation unit should cache some
|
|
|
|
* code-completion results with each reparse of the source file.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Caching of code-completion results is a performance optimization that
|
|
|
|
* introduces some overhead to reparsing but improves the performance of
|
|
|
|
* code-completion operations.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-10-28 01:24:53 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_CacheCompletionResults = 0x08,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2011-08-26 06:54:01 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief DEPRECATED: Enable precompiled preambles in C++.
|
2010-10-28 01:24:53 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Note: this is a *temporary* option that is available only while
|
2011-08-26 06:54:01 +08:00
|
|
|
* we are testing C++ precompiled preamble support. It is deprecated.
|
2010-10-28 01:24:53 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_CXXPrecompiledPreamble = 0x10,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2011-08-26 06:54:01 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief DEPRECATED: Enabled chained precompiled preambles in C++.
|
2010-10-28 01:24:53 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Note: this is a *temporary* option that is available only while
|
2011-08-26 06:54:01 +08:00
|
|
|
* we are testing C++ precompiled preamble support. It is deprecated.
|
2010-10-28 01:24:53 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-04-12 18:11:59 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_CXXChainedPCH = 0x20,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that function/method bodies should be skipped while
|
|
|
|
* parsing.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This option can be used to search for declarations/definitions while
|
|
|
|
* ignoring the usages.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-07-03 01:35:10 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_SkipFunctionBodies = 0x40,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that brief documentation comments should be
|
|
|
|
* included into the set of code completions returned from this translation
|
|
|
|
* unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit_IncludeBriefCommentsInCodeCompletion = 0x80
|
2010-07-22 02:52:53 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-10 06:28:58 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the set of flags that is suitable for parsing a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit that is being edited.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The set of flags returned provide options for \c clang_parseTranslationUnit()
|
|
|
|
* to indicate that the translation unit is likely to be reparsed many times,
|
|
|
|
* either explicitly (via \c clang_reparseTranslationUnit()) or implicitly
|
|
|
|
* (e.g., by code completion (\c clang_codeCompletionAt())). The returned flag
|
|
|
|
* set contains an unspecified set of optimizations (e.g., the precompiled
|
|
|
|
* preamble) geared toward improving the performance of these routines. The
|
|
|
|
* set of optimizations enabled may change from one version to the next.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-08-11 23:58:42 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_defaultEditingTranslationUnitOptions(void);
|
2010-08-10 06:28:58 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-07-22 02:52:53 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Parse the given source file and the translation unit corresponding
|
|
|
|
* to that file.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This routine is the main entry point for the Clang C API, providing the
|
|
|
|
* ability to parse a source file into a translation unit that can then be
|
|
|
|
* queried by other functions in the API. This routine accepts a set of
|
|
|
|
* command-line arguments so that the compilation can be configured in the same
|
|
|
|
* way that the compiler is configured on the command line.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param CIdx The index object with which the translation unit will be
|
|
|
|
* associated.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param source_filename The name of the source file to load, or NULL if the
|
2010-11-08 12:28:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* source file is included in \p command_line_args.
|
2010-07-22 02:52:53 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param command_line_args The command-line arguments that would be
|
|
|
|
* passed to the \c clang executable if it were being invoked out-of-process.
|
|
|
|
* These command-line options will be parsed and will affect how the translation
|
|
|
|
* unit is parsed. Note that the following options are ignored: '-c',
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* '-emit-ast', '-fsyntax-only' (which is the default), and '-o \<output file>'.
|
2010-07-22 02:52:53 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param num_command_line_args The number of command-line arguments in
|
|
|
|
* \p command_line_args.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param unsaved_files the files that have not yet been saved to disk
|
2010-08-05 00:47:14 +08:00
|
|
|
* but may be required for parsing, including the contents of
|
2010-07-22 02:52:53 +08:00
|
|
|
* those files. The contents and name of these files (as specified by
|
|
|
|
* CXUnsavedFile) are copied when necessary, so the client only needs to
|
|
|
|
* guarantee their validity until the call to this function returns.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param num_unsaved_files the number of unsaved file entries in \p
|
|
|
|
* unsaved_files.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param options A bitmask of options that affects how the translation unit
|
|
|
|
* is managed but not its compilation. This should be a bitwise OR of the
|
|
|
|
* CXTranslationUnit_XXX flags.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns A new translation unit describing the parsed code and containing
|
|
|
|
* any diagnostics produced by the compiler. If there is a failure from which
|
|
|
|
* the compiler cannot recover, returns NULL.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXTranslationUnit clang_parseTranslationUnit(CXIndex CIdx,
|
|
|
|
const char *source_filename,
|
2010-09-02 00:43:19 +08:00
|
|
|
const char * const *command_line_args,
|
2010-07-22 02:52:53 +08:00
|
|
|
int num_command_line_args,
|
|
|
|
struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files,
|
|
|
|
unsigned num_unsaved_files,
|
|
|
|
unsigned options);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-13 23:35:05 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Flags that control how translation units are saved.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The enumerators in this enumeration type are meant to be bitwise
|
|
|
|
* ORed together to specify which options should be used when
|
|
|
|
* saving the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXSaveTranslationUnit_Flags {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that no special saving options are needed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXSaveTranslationUnit_None = 0x0
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the set of flags that is suitable for saving a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The set of flags returned provide options for
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_saveTranslationUnit() by default. The returned flag
|
|
|
|
* set contains an unspecified set of options that save translation units with
|
|
|
|
* the most commonly-requested data.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_defaultSaveOptions(CXTranslationUnit TU);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-07-07 00:43:36 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes the kind of error that occurred (if any) in a call to
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_saveTranslationUnit().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXSaveError {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Indicates that no error occurred while saving a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXSaveError_None = 0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Indicates that an unknown error occurred while attempting to save
|
|
|
|
* the file.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This error typically indicates that file I/O failed when attempting to
|
|
|
|
* write the file.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXSaveError_Unknown = 1,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Indicates that errors during translation prevented this attempt
|
|
|
|
* to save the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Errors that prevent the translation unit from being saved can be
|
|
|
|
* extracted using \c clang_getNumDiagnostics() and \c clang_getDiagnostic().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXSaveError_TranslationErrors = 2,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Indicates that the translation unit to be saved was somehow
|
|
|
|
* invalid (e.g., NULL).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXSaveError_InvalidTU = 3
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-13 13:36:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Saves a translation unit into a serialized representation of
|
|
|
|
* that translation unit on disk.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Any translation unit that was parsed without error can be saved
|
|
|
|
* into a file. The translation unit can then be deserialized into a
|
|
|
|
* new \c CXTranslationUnit with \c clang_createTranslationUnit() or,
|
|
|
|
* if it is an incomplete translation unit that corresponds to a
|
|
|
|
* header, used as a precompiled header when parsing other translation
|
|
|
|
* units.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param TU The translation unit to save.
|
2010-08-13 23:35:05 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-08-13 13:36:37 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param FileName The file to which the translation unit will be saved.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-08-13 23:35:05 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param options A bitmask of options that affects how the translation unit
|
|
|
|
* is saved. This should be a bitwise OR of the
|
|
|
|
* CXSaveTranslationUnit_XXX flags.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2011-07-07 00:43:36 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns A value that will match one of the enumerators of the CXSaveError
|
|
|
|
* enumeration. Zero (CXSaveError_None) indicates that the translation unit was
|
|
|
|
* saved successfully, while a non-zero value indicates that a problem occurred.
|
2010-08-13 13:36:37 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_saveTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit TU,
|
2010-08-13 23:35:05 +08:00
|
|
|
const char *FileName,
|
|
|
|
unsigned options);
|
2010-08-13 13:36:37 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Destroy the specified CXTranslationUnit object.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_disposeTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-08-11 23:58:42 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Flags that control the reparsing of translation units.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The enumerators in this enumeration type are meant to be bitwise
|
|
|
|
* ORed together to specify which options should be used when
|
|
|
|
* reparsing the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXReparse_Flags {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that no special reparsing options are needed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXReparse_None = 0x0
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the set of flags that is suitable for reparsing a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The set of flags returned provide options for
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_reparseTranslationUnit() by default. The returned flag
|
|
|
|
* set contains an unspecified set of optimizations geared toward common uses
|
|
|
|
* of reparsing. The set of optimizations enabled may change from one version
|
|
|
|
* to the next.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_defaultReparseOptions(CXTranslationUnit TU);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-07-20 05:46:24 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Reparse the source files that produced this translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This routine can be used to re-parse the source files that originally
|
|
|
|
* created the given translation unit, for example because those source files
|
|
|
|
* have changed (either on disk or as passed via \p unsaved_files). The
|
|
|
|
* source code will be reparsed with the same command-line options as it
|
|
|
|
* was originally parsed.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Reparsing a translation unit invalidates all cursors and source locations
|
|
|
|
* that refer into that translation unit. This makes reparsing a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit semantically equivalent to destroying the translation unit and then
|
|
|
|
* creating a new translation unit with the same command-line arguments.
|
|
|
|
* However, it may be more efficient to reparse a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit using this routine.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param TU The translation unit whose contents will be re-parsed. The
|
|
|
|
* translation unit must originally have been built with
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_createTranslationUnitFromSourceFile().
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param num_unsaved_files The number of unsaved file entries in \p
|
|
|
|
* unsaved_files.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param unsaved_files The files that have not yet been saved to disk
|
|
|
|
* but may be required for parsing, including the contents of
|
|
|
|
* those files. The contents and name of these files (as specified by
|
|
|
|
* CXUnsavedFile) are copied when necessary, so the client only needs to
|
|
|
|
* guarantee their validity until the call to this function returns.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-08-11 23:58:42 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param options A bitset of options composed of the flags in CXReparse_Flags.
|
|
|
|
* The function \c clang_defaultReparseOptions() produces a default set of
|
|
|
|
* options recommended for most uses, based on the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-07-20 05:46:24 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns 0 if the sources could be reparsed. A non-zero value will be
|
|
|
|
* returned if reparsing was impossible, such that the translation unit is
|
|
|
|
* invalid. In such cases, the only valid call for \p TU is
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_disposeTranslationUnit(TU).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_reparseTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit TU,
|
|
|
|
unsigned num_unsaved_files,
|
2010-08-11 23:58:42 +08:00
|
|
|
struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files,
|
|
|
|
unsigned options);
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Categorizes how memory is being used by a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
enum CXTUResourceUsageKind {
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_AST = 1,
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_Identifiers = 2,
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_Selectors = 3,
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_GlobalCompletionResults = 4,
|
2011-04-28 12:10:31 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManagerContentCache = 5,
|
2011-04-28 12:53:38 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_AST_SideTables = 6,
|
2011-04-29 04:36:42 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_Malloc = 7,
|
2011-04-29 07:46:20 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_MMap = 8,
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_Malloc = 9,
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_MMap = 10,
|
2011-05-04 09:38:46 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor = 11,
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_PreprocessingRecord = 12,
|
2011-07-27 07:46:06 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_DataStructures = 13,
|
2011-07-27 07:46:11 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor_HeaderSearch = 14,
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_MEMORY_IN_BYTES_BEGIN = CXTUResourceUsage_AST,
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_MEMORY_IN_BYTES_END =
|
2011-07-27 07:46:11 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor_HeaderSearch,
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_First = CXTUResourceUsage_AST,
|
2011-07-27 07:46:11 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsage_Last = CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor_HeaderSearch
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the human-readable null-terminated C string that represents
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
* the name of the memory category. This string should never be freed.
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
const char *clang_getTUResourceUsageName(enum CXTUResourceUsageKind kind);
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct CXTUResourceUsageEntry {
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
/* \brief The memory usage category. */
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
enum CXTUResourceUsageKind kind;
|
|
|
|
/* \brief Amount of resources used.
|
|
|
|
The units will depend on the resource kind. */
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned long amount;
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXTUResourceUsageEntry;
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The memory usage of a CXTranslationUnit, broken into categories.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct CXTUResourceUsage {
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
/* \brief Private data member, used for queries. */
|
|
|
|
void *data;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* \brief The number of entries in the 'entries' array. */
|
|
|
|
unsigned numEntries;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* \brief An array of key-value pairs, representing the breakdown of memory
|
|
|
|
usage. */
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
CXTUResourceUsageEntry *entries;
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXTUResourceUsage;
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return the memory usage of a translation unit. This object
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
* should be released with clang_disposeCXTUResourceUsage().
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXTUResourceUsage clang_getCXTUResourceUsage(CXTranslationUnit TU);
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-04-21 00:41:07 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_disposeCXTUResourceUsage(CXTUResourceUsage usage);
|
2011-04-19 06:47:10 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-28 08:27:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes the kind of entity that a cursor refers to.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCursorKind {
|
|
|
|
/* Declarations */
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief A declaration whose specific kind is not exposed via this
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* interface.
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Unexposed declarations have the same operations as any other kind
|
|
|
|
* of declaration; one can extract their location information,
|
|
|
|
* spelling, find their definitions, etc. However, the specific kind
|
|
|
|
* of the declaration is not reported.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_UnexposedDecl = 1,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A C or C++ struct. */
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_StructDecl = 2,
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C or C++ union. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_UnionDecl = 3,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ class. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ClassDecl = 4,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An enumeration. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_EnumDecl = 5,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief A field (in C) or non-static data member (in C++) in a
|
|
|
|
* struct, union, or C++ class.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FieldDecl = 6,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An enumerator constant. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_EnumConstantDecl = 7,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A function. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FunctionDecl = 8,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A variable. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_VarDecl = 9,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A function or method parameter. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ParmDecl = 10,
|
2012-06-11 14:19:40 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@interface. */
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCInterfaceDecl = 11,
|
2012-06-11 14:19:40 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@interface for a category. */
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCCategoryDecl = 12,
|
2012-06-11 14:19:40 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@protocol declaration. */
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCProtocolDecl = 13,
|
2012-06-11 14:19:40 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@property declaration. */
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl = 14,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C instance variable. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCIvarDecl = 15,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C instance method. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl = 16,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C class method. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl = 17,
|
2012-06-11 14:19:40 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@implementation. */
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCImplementationDecl = 18,
|
2012-06-11 14:19:40 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@implementation for a category. */
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCCategoryImplDecl = 19,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A typedef */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_TypedefDecl = 20,
|
2010-04-14 07:39:06 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ class method. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXMethod = 21,
|
2010-05-07 07:38:21 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ namespace. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_Namespace = 22,
|
2010-05-07 09:04:29 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A linkage specification, e.g. 'extern "C"'. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LinkageSpec = 23,
|
2010-08-31 22:41:23 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ constructor. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_Constructor = 24,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ destructor. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_Destructor = 25,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ conversion function. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ConversionFunction = 26,
|
2010-09-01 01:01:39 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ template type parameter. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_TemplateTypeParameter = 27,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ non-type template parameter. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_NonTypeTemplateParameter = 28,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ template template parameter. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_TemplateTemplateParameter = 29,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ function template. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FunctionTemplate = 30,
|
2010-09-01 03:02:00 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ class template. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ClassTemplate = 31,
|
2010-09-01 03:31:58 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ class template partial specialization. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization = 32,
|
2010-09-01 07:48:11 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ namespace alias declaration. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_NamespaceAlias = 33,
|
2010-09-01 11:07:18 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ using directive. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_UsingDirective = 34,
|
2011-04-15 22:24:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ using declaration. */
|
2010-09-02 03:52:22 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_UsingDeclaration = 35,
|
2011-04-15 22:24:37 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ alias declaration */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_TypeAliasDecl = 36,
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@synthesize definition. */
|
2011-06-04 07:08:58 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCSynthesizeDecl = 37,
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@dynamic definition. */
|
2011-06-04 07:08:58 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCDynamicDecl = 38,
|
2011-10-01 01:58:23 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An access specifier. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXAccessSpecifier = 39,
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-05-20 05:51:10 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_FirstDecl = CXCursor_UnexposedDecl,
|
2011-10-01 01:58:23 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_LastDecl = CXCursor_CXXAccessSpecifier,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/* References */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FirstRef = 40, /* Decl references */
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef = 40,
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef = 41,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCClassRef = 42,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A reference to a type declaration.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A type reference occurs anywhere where a type is named but not
|
|
|
|
* declared. For example, given:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* typedef unsigned size_type;
|
|
|
|
* size_type size;
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The typedef is a declaration of size_type (CXCursor_TypedefDecl),
|
|
|
|
* while the type of the variable "size" is referenced. The cursor
|
|
|
|
* referenced by the type of size is the typedef for size_type.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_TypeRef = 43,
|
2010-08-28 05:34:58 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier = 44,
|
2010-09-01 04:37:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-09-10 05:42:20 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief A reference to a class template, function template, template
|
|
|
|
* template parameter, or class template partial specialization.
|
2010-09-01 04:37:03 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_TemplateRef = 45,
|
2010-09-01 07:48:11 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A reference to a namespace or namespace alias.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_NamespaceRef = 46,
|
2010-09-10 05:42:20 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-09-10 08:22:18 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief A reference to a member of a struct, union, or class that occurs in
|
|
|
|
* some non-expression context, e.g., a designated initializer.
|
2010-09-10 05:42:20 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_MemberRef = 47,
|
2010-09-10 08:22:18 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A reference to a labeled statement.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This cursor kind is used to describe the jump to "start_over" in the
|
|
|
|
* goto statement in the following example:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* start_over:
|
|
|
|
* ++counter;
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* goto start_over;
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A label reference cursor refers to a label statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LabelRef = 48,
|
|
|
|
|
2010-09-14 06:52:57 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A reference to a set of overloaded functions or function templates
|
|
|
|
* that has not yet been resolved to a specific function or function template.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* An overloaded declaration reference cursor occurs in C++ templates where
|
|
|
|
* a dependent name refers to a function. For example:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* template<typename T> void swap(T&, T&);
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* struct X { ... };
|
|
|
|
* void swap(X&, X&);
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* template<typename T>
|
|
|
|
* void reverse(T* first, T* last) {
|
|
|
|
* while (first < last - 1) {
|
|
|
|
* swap(*first, *--last);
|
|
|
|
* ++first;
|
|
|
|
* }
|
|
|
|
* }
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* struct Y { };
|
|
|
|
* void swap(Y&, Y&);
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Here, the identifier "swap" is associated with an overloaded declaration
|
|
|
|
* reference. In the template definition, "swap" refers to either of the two
|
|
|
|
* "swap" functions declared above, so both results will be available. At
|
|
|
|
* instantiation time, "swap" may also refer to other functions found via
|
|
|
|
* argument-dependent lookup (e.g., the "swap" function at the end of the
|
|
|
|
* example).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The functions \c clang_getNumOverloadedDecls() and
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_getOverloadedDecl() can be used to retrieve the definitions
|
|
|
|
* referenced by this cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef = 49,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-02-15 08:54:55 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A reference to a variable that occurs in some non-expression
|
|
|
|
* context, e.g., a C++ lambda capture list.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_VariableRef = 50,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LastRef = CXCursor_VariableRef,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/* Error conditions */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FirstInvalid = 70,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_InvalidFile = 70,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_NoDeclFound = 71,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_NotImplemented = 72,
|
2010-03-20 04:39:03 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_InvalidCode = 73,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LastInvalid = CXCursor_InvalidCode,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/* Expressions */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FirstExpr = 100,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An expression whose specific kind is not exposed via this
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* interface.
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Unexposed expressions have the same operations as any other kind
|
|
|
|
* of expression; one can extract their location information,
|
|
|
|
* spelling, children, etc. However, the specific kind of the
|
|
|
|
* expression is not reported.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_UnexposedExpr = 100,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An expression that refers to some value declaration, such
|
|
|
|
* as a function, varible, or enumerator.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_DeclRefExpr = 101,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An expression that refers to a member of a struct, union,
|
|
|
|
* class, Objective-C class, etc.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_MemberRefExpr = 102,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An expression that calls a function. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CallExpr = 103,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An expression that sends a message to an Objective-C
|
|
|
|
object or class. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCMessageExpr = 104,
|
2010-04-12 05:47:37 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An expression that represents a block literal. */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_BlockExpr = 105,
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An integer literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_IntegerLiteral = 106,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A floating point number literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FloatingLiteral = 107,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An imaginary number literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ImaginaryLiteral = 108,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A string literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_StringLiteral = 109,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A character literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CharacterLiteral = 110,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A parenthesized expression, e.g. "(1)".
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This AST node is only formed if full location information is requested.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ParenExpr = 111,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief This represents the unary-expression's (except sizeof and
|
|
|
|
* alignof).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_UnaryOperator = 112,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief [C99 6.5.2.1] Array Subscripting.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ArraySubscriptExpr = 113,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A builtin binary operation expression such as "x + y" or
|
|
|
|
* "x <= y".
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_BinaryOperator = 114,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Compound assignment such as "+=".
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CompoundAssignOperator = 115,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief The ?: ternary operator.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ConditionalOperator = 116,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An explicit cast in C (C99 6.5.4) or a C-style cast in C++
|
|
|
|
* (C++ [expr.cast]), which uses the syntax (Type)expr.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example: (int)f.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CStyleCastExpr = 117,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief [C99 6.5.2.5]
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CompoundLiteralExpr = 118,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Describes an C or C++ initializer list.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_InitListExpr = 119,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief The GNU address of label extension, representing &&label.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_AddrLabelExpr = 120,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief This is the GNU Statement Expression extension: ({int X=4; X;})
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_StmtExpr = 121,
|
|
|
|
|
2011-12-24 01:00:35 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief Represents a C11 generic selection.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_GenericSelectionExpr = 122,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Implements the GNU __null extension, which is a name for a null
|
|
|
|
* pointer constant that has integral type (e.g., int or long) and is the same
|
|
|
|
* size and alignment as a pointer.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The __null extension is typically only used by system headers, which define
|
|
|
|
* NULL as __null in C++ rather than using 0 (which is an integer that may not
|
|
|
|
* match the size of a pointer).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_GNUNullExpr = 123,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief C++'s static_cast<> expression.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXStaticCastExpr = 124,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief C++'s dynamic_cast<> expression.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXDynamicCastExpr = 125,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief C++'s reinterpret_cast<> expression.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXReinterpretCastExpr = 126,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief C++'s const_cast<> expression.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXConstCastExpr = 127,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Represents an explicit C++ type conversion that uses "functional"
|
|
|
|
* notion (C++ [expr.type.conv]).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Example:
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* x = int(0.5);
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXFunctionalCastExpr = 128,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A C++ typeid expression (C++ [expr.typeid]).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXTypeidExpr = 129,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief [C++ 2.13.5] C++ Boolean Literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXBoolLiteralExpr = 130,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief [C++0x 2.14.7] C++ Pointer Literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXNullPtrLiteralExpr = 131,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Represents the "this" expression in C++
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXThisExpr = 132,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief [C++ 15] C++ Throw Expression.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This handles 'throw' and 'throw' assignment-expression. When
|
|
|
|
* assignment-expression isn't present, Op will be null.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXThrowExpr = 133,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A new expression for memory allocation and constructor calls, e.g:
|
|
|
|
* "new CXXNewExpr(foo)".
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXNewExpr = 134,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A delete expression for memory deallocation and destructor calls,
|
|
|
|
* e.g. "delete[] pArray".
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXDeleteExpr = 135,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A unary expression.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_UnaryExpr = 136,
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-12 06:35:18 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C string literal i.e. @"foo".
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCStringLiteral = 137,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@encode expression.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCEncodeExpr = 138,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@selector expression.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCSelectorExpr = 139,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-11 14:19:40 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C \@protocol expression.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCProtocolExpr = 140,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An Objective-C "bridged" cast expression, which casts between
|
|
|
|
* Objective-C pointers and C pointers, transferring ownership in the process.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* NSString *str = (__bridge_transfer NSString *)CFCreateString();
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCBridgedCastExpr = 141,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Represents a C++0x pack expansion that produces a sequence of
|
|
|
|
* expressions.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A pack expansion expression contains a pattern (which itself is an
|
|
|
|
* expression) followed by an ellipsis. For example:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* template<typename F, typename ...Types>
|
|
|
|
* void forward(F f, Types &&...args) {
|
|
|
|
* f(static_cast<Types&&>(args)...);
|
|
|
|
* }
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_PackExpansionExpr = 142,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Represents an expression that computes the length of a parameter
|
|
|
|
* pack.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* template<typename ...Types>
|
|
|
|
* struct count {
|
|
|
|
* static const unsigned value = sizeof...(Types);
|
|
|
|
* };
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_SizeOfPackExpr = 143,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-02-15 08:54:55 +08:00
|
|
|
/* \brief Represents a C++ lambda expression that produces a local function
|
|
|
|
* object.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* void abssort(float *x, unsigned N) {
|
|
|
|
* std::sort(x, x + N,
|
|
|
|
* [](float a, float b) {
|
|
|
|
* return std::abs(a) < std::abs(b);
|
|
|
|
* });
|
|
|
|
* }
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LambdaExpr = 144,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-03-07 04:06:06 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief Objective-c Boolean Literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCBoolLiteralExpr = 145,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LastExpr = CXCursor_ObjCBoolLiteralExpr,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/* Statements */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FirstStmt = 200,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A statement whose specific kind is not exposed via this
|
|
|
|
* interface.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Unexposed statements have the same operations as any other kind of
|
|
|
|
* statement; one can extract their location information, spelling,
|
|
|
|
* children, etc. However, the specific kind of the statement is not
|
|
|
|
* reported.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_UnexposedStmt = 200,
|
2010-09-10 08:22:18 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A labelled statement in a function.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This cursor kind is used to describe the "start_over:" label statement in
|
|
|
|
* the following example:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* start_over:
|
|
|
|
* ++counter;
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LabelStmt = 201,
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A group of statements like { stmt stmt }.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This cursor kind is used to describe compound statements, e.g. function
|
|
|
|
* bodies.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CompoundStmt = 202,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A case statment.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CaseStmt = 203,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A default statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_DefaultStmt = 204,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An if statement
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_IfStmt = 205,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A switch statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_SwitchStmt = 206,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A while statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_WhileStmt = 207,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A do statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_DoStmt = 208,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A for statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ForStmt = 209,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A goto statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_GotoStmt = 210,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief An indirect goto statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_IndirectGotoStmt = 211,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A continue statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ContinueStmt = 212,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A break statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_BreakStmt = 213,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A return statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ReturnStmt = 214,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief A GNU inline assembly statement extension.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_AsmStmt = 215,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief Objective-C's overall \@try-\@catch-\@finally statement.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCAtTryStmt = 216,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief Objective-C's \@catch statement.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCAtCatchStmt = 217,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief Objective-C's \@finally statement.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCAtFinallyStmt = 218,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief Objective-C's \@throw statement.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCAtThrowStmt = 219,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief Objective-C's \@synchronized statement.
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCAtSynchronizedStmt = 220,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Objective-C's autorelease pool statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCAutoreleasePoolStmt = 221,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Objective-C's collection statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_ObjCForCollectionStmt = 222,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief C++'s catch statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXCatchStmt = 223,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief C++'s try statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXTryStmt = 224,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief C++'s for (* : *) statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXForRangeStmt = 225,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Windows Structured Exception Handling's try statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_SEHTryStmt = 226,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Windows Structured Exception Handling's except statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_SEHExceptStmt = 227,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Windows Structured Exception Handling's finally statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_SEHFinallyStmt = 228,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-12 04:47:18 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief A MS inline assembly statement extension.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_MSAsmStmt = 229,
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-06 03:00:14 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief The null satement ";": C99 6.8.3p3.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This cursor kind is used to describe the null statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_NullStmt = 230,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \brief Adaptor class for mixing declarations with statements and
|
|
|
|
* expressions.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_DeclStmt = 231,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LastStmt = CXCursor_DeclStmt,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Cursor that represents the translation unit itself.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The translation unit cursor exists primarily to act as the root
|
|
|
|
* cursor for traversing the contents of a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-02-18 11:09:07 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_TranslationUnit = 300,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Attributes */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_FirstAttr = 400,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An attribute whose specific kind is not exposed via this
|
|
|
|
* interface.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_UnexposedAttr = 400,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_IBActionAttr = 401,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_IBOutletAttr = 402,
|
2010-05-20 01:38:06 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_IBOutletCollectionAttr = 403,
|
2011-09-14 01:39:31 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXFinalAttr = 404,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_CXXOverrideAttr = 405,
|
2011-10-13 17:41:32 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_AnnotateAttr = 406,
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_AsmLabelAttr = 407,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_LastAttr = CXCursor_AsmLabelAttr,
|
2010-03-18 08:42:48 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Preprocessing */
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_PreprocessingDirective = 500,
|
2010-03-19 02:04:21 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_MacroDefinition = 501,
|
2011-07-14 16:41:15 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_MacroExpansion = 502,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor_MacroInstantiation = CXCursor_MacroExpansion,
|
2010-10-21 06:00:55 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_InclusionDirective = 503,
|
2010-03-18 08:42:48 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_FirstPreprocessing = CXCursor_PreprocessingDirective,
|
2010-10-21 06:00:55 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor_LastPreprocessing = CXCursor_InclusionDirective
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A cursor representing some element in the abstract syntax tree for
|
|
|
|
* a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* The cursor abstraction unifies the different kinds of entities in a
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* program--declaration, statements, expressions, references to declarations,
|
|
|
|
* etc.--under a single "cursor" abstraction with a common set of operations.
|
|
|
|
* Common operation for a cursor include: getting the physical location in
|
|
|
|
* a source file where the cursor points, getting the name associated with a
|
|
|
|
* cursor, and retrieving cursors for any child nodes of a particular cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Cursors can be produced in two specific ways.
|
|
|
|
* clang_getTranslationUnitCursor() produces a cursor for a translation unit,
|
|
|
|
* from which one can use clang_visitChildren() to explore the rest of the
|
|
|
|
* translation unit. clang_getCursor() maps from a physical source location
|
|
|
|
* to the entity that resides at that location, allowing one to map from the
|
|
|
|
* source code into the AST.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
enum CXCursorKind kind;
|
2011-10-06 15:00:54 +08:00
|
|
|
int xdata;
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
void *data[3];
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXCursor;
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A comment AST node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
const void *Data;
|
|
|
|
} CXComment;
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_CURSOR_MANIP Cursor manipulations
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the NULL cursor, which represents no entity.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getNullCursor(void);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the cursor that represents the given translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The translation unit cursor can be used to start traversing the
|
|
|
|
* various declarations within the given translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getTranslationUnitCursor(CXTranslationUnit);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether two cursors are equivalent.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_equalCursors(CXCursor, CXCursor);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-09-27 08:30:30 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns non-zero if \arg cursor is null.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-02-02 04:37:28 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_Cursor_isNull(CXCursor);
|
2011-09-27 08:30:30 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-11-20 08:09:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Compute a hash value for the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_hashCursor(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the kind of the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXCursorKind clang_getCursorKind(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor kind represents a declaration.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isDeclaration(enum CXCursorKind);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor kind represents a simple
|
|
|
|
* reference.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Note that other kinds of cursors (such as expressions) can also refer to
|
|
|
|
* other cursors. Use clang_getCursorReferenced() to determine whether a
|
|
|
|
* particular cursor refers to another entity.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isReference(enum CXCursorKind);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor kind represents an expression.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isExpression(enum CXCursorKind);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor kind represents a statement.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isStatement(enum CXCursorKind);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-07-06 11:00:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor kind represents an attribute.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isAttribute(enum CXCursorKind);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor kind represents an invalid
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* cursor.
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isInvalid(enum CXCursorKind);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor kind represents a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit.
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isTranslationUnit(enum CXCursorKind);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-03-18 08:42:48 +08:00
|
|
|
/***
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor represents a preprocessing
|
|
|
|
* element, such as a preprocessor directive or macro instantiation.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isPreprocessing(enum CXCursorKind);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-03-09 05:17:29 +08:00
|
|
|
/***
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the given cursor represents a currently
|
|
|
|
* unexposed piece of the AST (e.g., CXCursor_UnexposedStmt).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isUnexposed(enum CXCursorKind);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-03-03 14:36:57 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describe the linkage of the entity referred to by a cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXLinkageKind {
|
|
|
|
/** \brief This value indicates that no linkage information is available
|
|
|
|
* for a provided CXCursor. */
|
|
|
|
CXLinkage_Invalid,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief This is the linkage for variables, parameters, and so on that
|
|
|
|
* have automatic storage. This covers normal (non-extern) local variables.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXLinkage_NoLinkage,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief This is the linkage for static variables and static functions. */
|
|
|
|
CXLinkage_Internal,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief This is the linkage for entities with external linkage that live
|
|
|
|
* in C++ anonymous namespaces.*/
|
|
|
|
CXLinkage_UniqueExternal,
|
|
|
|
/** \brief This is the linkage for entities with true, external linkage. */
|
|
|
|
CXLinkage_External
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-04-13 05:22:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the linkage of the entity referred to by a given cursor.
|
2010-03-03 14:36:57 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXLinkageKind clang_getCursorLinkage(CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-05-08 08:14:45 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the availability of the entity that this cursor refers to,
|
|
|
|
* taking the current target platform into account.
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param cursor The cursor to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The availability of the cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXAvailabilityKind
|
|
|
|
clang_getCursorAvailability(CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-05-08 08:14:45 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* Describes the availability of a given entity on a particular platform, e.g.,
|
|
|
|
* a particular class might only be available on Mac OS 10.7 or newer.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct CXPlatformAvailability {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A string that describes the platform for which this structure
|
|
|
|
* provides availability information.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Possible values are "ios" or "macosx".
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXString Platform;
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The version number in which this entity was introduced.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXVersion Introduced;
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The version number in which this entity was deprecated (but is
|
|
|
|
* still available).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXVersion Deprecated;
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The version number in which this entity was obsoleted, and therefore
|
|
|
|
* is no longer available.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXVersion Obsoleted;
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Whether the entity is unconditionally unavailable on this platform.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int Unavailable;
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An optional message to provide to a user of this API, e.g., to
|
|
|
|
* suggest replacement APIs.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXString Message;
|
|
|
|
} CXPlatformAvailability;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the availability of the entity that this cursor refers to
|
|
|
|
* on any platforms for which availability information is known.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param cursor The cursor to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param always_deprecated If non-NULL, will be set to indicate whether the
|
|
|
|
* entity is deprecated on all platforms.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param deprecated_message If non-NULL, will be set to the message text
|
|
|
|
* provided along with the unconditional deprecation of this entity. The client
|
|
|
|
* is responsible for deallocating this string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param always_unavailable If non-NULL, will be set to indicate whether the
|
2012-05-08 08:14:45 +08:00
|
|
|
* entity is unavailable on all platforms.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param unavailable_message If non-NULL, will be set to the message text
|
|
|
|
* provided along with the unconditional unavailability of this entity. The
|
|
|
|
* client is responsible for deallocating this string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param availability If non-NULL, an array of CXPlatformAvailability instances
|
|
|
|
* that will be populated with platform availability information, up to either
|
|
|
|
* the number of platforms for which availability information is available (as
|
|
|
|
* returned by this function) or \c availability_size, whichever is smaller.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param availability_size The number of elements available in the
|
|
|
|
* \c availability array.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The number of platforms (N) for which availability information is
|
|
|
|
* available (which is unrelated to \c availability_size).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Note that the client is responsible for calling
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_disposeCXPlatformAvailability to free each of the
|
|
|
|
* platform-availability structures returned. There are
|
|
|
|
* \c min(N, availability_size) such structures.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int
|
|
|
|
clang_getCursorPlatformAvailability(CXCursor cursor,
|
|
|
|
int *always_deprecated,
|
|
|
|
CXString *deprecated_message,
|
|
|
|
int *always_unavailable,
|
|
|
|
CXString *unavailable_message,
|
|
|
|
CXPlatformAvailability *availability,
|
|
|
|
int availability_size);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Free the memory associated with a \c CXPlatformAvailability structure.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void
|
|
|
|
clang_disposeCXPlatformAvailability(CXPlatformAvailability *availability);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-04-13 05:22:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describe the "language" of the entity referred to by a cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXLanguageKind {
|
2010-04-15 04:58:32 +08:00
|
|
|
CXLanguage_Invalid = 0,
|
2010-04-13 05:22:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXLanguage_C,
|
|
|
|
CXLanguage_ObjC,
|
2010-04-15 04:58:32 +08:00
|
|
|
CXLanguage_CPlusPlus
|
2010-04-13 05:22:16 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the "language" of the entity referred to by a given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXLanguageKind clang_getCursorLanguage(CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-09-27 08:30:30 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the translation unit that a cursor originated from.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXTranslationUnit clang_Cursor_getTranslationUnit(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-12-09 07:43:14 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A fast container representing a set of CXCursors.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct CXCursorSetImpl *CXCursorSet;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Creates an empty CXCursorSet.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursorSet clang_createCXCursorSet();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Disposes a CXCursorSet and releases its associated memory.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_disposeCXCursorSet(CXCursorSet cset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Queries a CXCursorSet to see if it contains a specific CXCursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if the set contains the specified cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_CXCursorSet_contains(CXCursorSet cset,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Inserts a CXCursor into a CXCursorSet.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns zero if the CXCursor was already in the set, and non-zero otherwise.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_CXCursorSet_insert(CXCursorSet cset,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-09-23 05:22:29 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the semantic parent of the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The semantic parent of a cursor is the cursor that semantically contains
|
|
|
|
* the given \p cursor. For many declarations, the lexical and semantic parents
|
|
|
|
* are equivalent (the lexical parent is returned by
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_getCursorLexicalParent()). They diverge when declarations or
|
|
|
|
* definitions are provided out-of-line. For example:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* class C {
|
|
|
|
* void f();
|
|
|
|
* };
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* void C::f() { }
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* In the out-of-line definition of \c C::f, the semantic parent is the
|
|
|
|
* the class \c C, of which this function is a member. The lexical parent is
|
|
|
|
* the place where the declaration actually occurs in the source code; in this
|
|
|
|
* case, the definition occurs in the translation unit. In general, the
|
|
|
|
* lexical parent for a given entity can change without affecting the semantics
|
|
|
|
* of the program, and the lexical parent of different declarations of the
|
|
|
|
* same entity may be different. Changing the semantic parent of a declaration,
|
|
|
|
* on the other hand, can have a major impact on semantics, and redeclarations
|
|
|
|
* of a particular entity should all have the same semantic context.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* In the example above, both declarations of \c C::f have \c C as their
|
|
|
|
* semantic context, while the lexical context of the first \c C::f is \c C
|
|
|
|
* and the lexical context of the second \c C::f is the translation unit.
|
2010-12-21 15:55:45 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For global declarations, the semantic parent is the translation unit.
|
2010-09-23 05:22:29 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getCursorSemanticParent(CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the lexical parent of the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The lexical parent of a cursor is the cursor in which the given \p cursor
|
|
|
|
* was actually written. For many declarations, the lexical and semantic parents
|
|
|
|
* are equivalent (the semantic parent is returned by
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_getCursorSemanticParent()). They diverge when declarations or
|
|
|
|
* definitions are provided out-of-line. For example:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* class C {
|
|
|
|
* void f();
|
|
|
|
* };
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* void C::f() { }
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* In the out-of-line definition of \c C::f, the semantic parent is the
|
|
|
|
* the class \c C, of which this function is a member. The lexical parent is
|
|
|
|
* the place where the declaration actually occurs in the source code; in this
|
|
|
|
* case, the definition occurs in the translation unit. In general, the
|
|
|
|
* lexical parent for a given entity can change without affecting the semantics
|
|
|
|
* of the program, and the lexical parent of different declarations of the
|
|
|
|
* same entity may be different. Changing the semantic parent of a declaration,
|
|
|
|
* on the other hand, can have a major impact on semantics, and redeclarations
|
|
|
|
* of a particular entity should all have the same semantic context.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* In the example above, both declarations of \c C::f have \c C as their
|
|
|
|
* semantic context, while the lexical context of the first \c C::f is \c C
|
|
|
|
* and the lexical context of the second \c C::f is the translation unit.
|
2010-12-21 15:55:45 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For declarations written in the global scope, the lexical parent is
|
|
|
|
* the translation unit.
|
2010-09-23 05:22:29 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getCursorLexicalParent(CXCursor cursor);
|
2010-10-02 04:25:15 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the set of methods that are overridden by the given
|
|
|
|
* method.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* In both Objective-C and C++, a method (aka virtual member function,
|
|
|
|
* in C++) can override a virtual method in a base class. For
|
|
|
|
* Objective-C, a method is said to override any method in the class's
|
[libclang] Enhance clang_getOverriddenCursors.
Basically the current design is:
-for an implementation method, show as overridden the interface method.
This is not useful, and is inconsistent with the C++ side
-for an interface method, show as overridden the protocols methods (this is desirable)
and the methods from the categories; methods from categories are not useful
since they are considered the same method (same USR).
-If there is a protocol method or category method reported, it does not check the
super class for overridden methods. This is really problematic since
overridden methods from super class is what we want to give back.
Change clang_getOverriddenCursors to show as overridden any method in the class's
base class, its protocols, or its categories' protocols, that has the same
selector and is of the same kind (class or instance).
If no such method exists, the search continues to the class's superclass,
its protocols, and its categories, and so on. A method from an Objective-C
implementation is considered to override the same methods as its
corresponding method in the interface.
rdar://10967206
llvm-svn: 152270
2012-03-08 08:20:03 +08:00
|
|
|
* base class, its protocols, or its categories' protocols, that has the same
|
|
|
|
* selector and is of the same kind (class or instance).
|
|
|
|
* If no such method exists, the search continues to the class's superclass,
|
|
|
|
* its protocols, and its categories, and so on. A method from an Objective-C
|
|
|
|
* implementation is considered to override the same methods as its
|
|
|
|
* corresponding method in the interface.
|
2010-10-02 04:25:15 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For C++, a virtual member function overrides any virtual member
|
|
|
|
* function with the same signature that occurs in its base
|
|
|
|
* classes. With multiple inheritance, a virtual member function can
|
|
|
|
* override several virtual member functions coming from different
|
|
|
|
* base classes.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* In all cases, this function determines the immediate overridden
|
|
|
|
* method, rather than all of the overridden methods. For example, if
|
|
|
|
* a method is originally declared in a class A, then overridden in B
|
|
|
|
* (which in inherits from A) and also in C (which inherited from B),
|
|
|
|
* then the only overridden method returned from this function when
|
|
|
|
* invoked on C's method will be B's method. The client may then
|
|
|
|
* invoke this function again, given the previously-found overridden
|
|
|
|
* methods, to map out the complete method-override set.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param cursor A cursor representing an Objective-C or C++
|
|
|
|
* method. This routine will compute the set of methods that this
|
|
|
|
* method overrides.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param overridden A pointer whose pointee will be replaced with a
|
|
|
|
* pointer to an array of cursors, representing the set of overridden
|
|
|
|
* methods. If there are no overridden methods, the pointee will be
|
|
|
|
* set to NULL. The pointee must be freed via a call to
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_disposeOverriddenCursors().
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param num_overridden A pointer to the number of overridden
|
|
|
|
* functions, will be set to the number of overridden functions in the
|
|
|
|
* array pointed to by \p overridden.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_getOverriddenCursors(CXCursor cursor,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor **overridden,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *num_overridden);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Free the set of overridden cursors returned by \c
|
|
|
|
* clang_getOverriddenCursors().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_disposeOverriddenCursors(CXCursor *overridden);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-10-21 06:00:55 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the file that is included by the given inclusion directive
|
|
|
|
* cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXFile clang_getIncludedFile(CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-21 06:45:41 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_CURSOR_SOURCE Mapping between cursors and source code
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Cursors represent a location within the Abstract Syntax Tree (AST). These
|
|
|
|
* routines help map between cursors and the physical locations where the
|
|
|
|
* described entities occur in the source code. The mapping is provided in
|
|
|
|
* both directions, so one can map from source code to the AST and back.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
2009-08-28 23:28:48 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-10-21 21:56:23 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Map a source location to the cursor that describes the entity at that
|
|
|
|
* location in the source code.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* clang_getCursor() maps an arbitrary source location within a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit down to the most specific cursor that describes the entity at that
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* location. For example, given an expression \c x + y, invoking
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
* clang_getCursor() with a source location pointing to "x" will return the
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* cursor for "x"; similarly for "y". If the cursor points anywhere between
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
* "x" or "y" (e.g., on the + or the whitespace around it), clang_getCursor()
|
|
|
|
* will return a cursor referring to the "+" expression.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns a cursor representing the entity at the given source location, or
|
|
|
|
* a NULL cursor if no such entity can be found.
|
2009-10-21 21:56:23 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-23 05:44:22 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getCursor(CXTranslationUnit, CXSourceLocation);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-19 06:46:11 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the physical location of the source constructor referenced
|
|
|
|
* by the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The location of a declaration is typically the location of the name of that
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* declaration, where the name of that declaration would occur if it is
|
|
|
|
* unnamed, or some keyword that introduces that particular declaration.
|
|
|
|
* The location of a reference is where that reference occurs within the
|
2010-01-19 06:46:11 +08:00
|
|
|
* source code.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceLocation clang_getCursorLocation(CXCursor);
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-20 03:34:47 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the physical extent of the source construct referenced by
|
2010-01-19 08:34:46 +08:00
|
|
|
* the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The extent of a cursor starts with the file/line/column pointing at the
|
|
|
|
* first character within the source construct that the cursor refers to and
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* ends with the last character withinin that source construct. For a
|
2010-01-19 08:34:46 +08:00
|
|
|
* declaration, the extent covers the declaration itself. For a reference,
|
|
|
|
* the extent covers the location of the reference (e.g., where the referenced
|
|
|
|
* entity was actually used).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceRange clang_getCursorExtent(CXCursor);
|
2010-01-19 09:20:04 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-08-26 09:42:22 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_TYPES Type information for CXCursors
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes the kind of type
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXTypeKind {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Reprents an invalid type (e.g., where no type is available).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXType_Invalid = 0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A type whose specific kind is not exposed via this
|
|
|
|
* interface.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXType_Unexposed = 1,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Builtin types */
|
|
|
|
CXType_Void = 2,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Bool = 3,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Char_U = 4,
|
|
|
|
CXType_UChar = 5,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Char16 = 6,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Char32 = 7,
|
|
|
|
CXType_UShort = 8,
|
|
|
|
CXType_UInt = 9,
|
|
|
|
CXType_ULong = 10,
|
|
|
|
CXType_ULongLong = 11,
|
|
|
|
CXType_UInt128 = 12,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Char_S = 13,
|
|
|
|
CXType_SChar = 14,
|
|
|
|
CXType_WChar = 15,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Short = 16,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Int = 17,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Long = 18,
|
|
|
|
CXType_LongLong = 19,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Int128 = 20,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Float = 21,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Double = 22,
|
|
|
|
CXType_LongDouble = 23,
|
|
|
|
CXType_NullPtr = 24,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Overload = 25,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Dependent = 26,
|
|
|
|
CXType_ObjCId = 27,
|
|
|
|
CXType_ObjCClass = 28,
|
|
|
|
CXType_ObjCSel = 29,
|
|
|
|
CXType_FirstBuiltin = CXType_Void,
|
|
|
|
CXType_LastBuiltin = CXType_ObjCSel,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CXType_Complex = 100,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Pointer = 101,
|
|
|
|
CXType_BlockPointer = 102,
|
|
|
|
CXType_LValueReference = 103,
|
|
|
|
CXType_RValueReference = 104,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Record = 105,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Enum = 106,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Typedef = 107,
|
|
|
|
CXType_ObjCInterface = 108,
|
2010-06-22 04:15:39 +08:00
|
|
|
CXType_ObjCObjectPointer = 109,
|
|
|
|
CXType_FunctionNoProto = 110,
|
2011-09-28 01:44:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CXType_FunctionProto = 111,
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
CXType_ConstantArray = 112,
|
|
|
|
CXType_Vector = 113
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes the calling convention of a function type
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCallingConv {
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_Default = 0,
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_C = 1,
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_X86StdCall = 2,
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_X86FastCall = 3,
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_X86ThisCall = 4,
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_X86Pascal = 5,
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_AAPCS = 6,
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_AAPCS_VFP = 7,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_Invalid = 100,
|
|
|
|
CXCallingConv_Unexposed = 200
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The type of an element in the abstract syntax tree.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
enum CXTypeKind kind;
|
|
|
|
void *data[2];
|
|
|
|
} CXType;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the type of a CXCursor (if any).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getCursorType(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the underlying type of a typedef declaration.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If the cursor does not reference a typedef declaration, an invalid type is
|
|
|
|
* returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getTypedefDeclUnderlyingType(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the integer type of an enum declaration.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If the cursor does not reference an enum declaration, an invalid type is
|
|
|
|
* returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getEnumDeclIntegerType(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the integer value of an enum constant declaration as a signed
|
|
|
|
* long long.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If the cursor does not reference an enum constant declaration, LLONG_MIN is returned.
|
|
|
|
* Since this is also potentially a valid constant value, the kind of the cursor
|
|
|
|
* must be verified before calling this function.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE long long clang_getEnumConstantDeclValue(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the integer value of an enum constant declaration as an unsigned
|
|
|
|
* long long.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If the cursor does not reference an enum constant declaration, ULLONG_MAX is returned.
|
|
|
|
* Since this is also potentially a valid constant value, the kind of the cursor
|
|
|
|
* must be verified before calling this function.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned long long clang_getEnumConstantDeclUnsignedValue(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-04-12 03:32:19 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the number of non-variadic arguments associated with a given
|
|
|
|
* cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If a cursor that is not a function or method is passed in, -1 is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_Cursor_getNumArguments(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the argument cursor of a function or method.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If a cursor that is not a function or method is passed in or the index
|
|
|
|
* exceeds the number of arguments, an invalid cursor is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_Cursor_getArgument(CXCursor C, unsigned i);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether two CXTypes represent the same type.
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if the CXTypes represent the same type and
|
|
|
|
* zero otherwise.
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_equalTypes(CXType A, CXType B);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return the canonical type for a CXType.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Clang's type system explicitly models typedefs and all the ways
|
|
|
|
* a specific type can be represented. The canonical type is the underlying
|
|
|
|
* type with all the "sugar" removed. For example, if 'T' is a typedef
|
|
|
|
* for 'int', the canonical type for 'T' would be 'int'.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getCanonicalType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-01-28 00:27:11 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether a CXType has the "const" qualifier set,
|
|
|
|
* without looking through typedefs that may have added "const" at a
|
|
|
|
* different level.
|
2011-01-28 00:27:11 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isConstQualifiedType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether a CXType has the "volatile" qualifier set,
|
|
|
|
* without looking through typedefs that may have added "volatile" at
|
|
|
|
* a different level.
|
2011-01-28 00:27:11 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isVolatileQualifiedType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether a CXType has the "restrict" qualifier set,
|
|
|
|
* without looking through typedefs that may have added "restrict" at a
|
|
|
|
* different level.
|
2011-01-28 00:27:11 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isRestrictQualifiedType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief For pointer types, returns the type of the pointee.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getPointeeType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return the cursor for the declaration of the given type.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getTypeDeclaration(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-12-30 22:05:53 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* Returns the Objective-C type encoding for the specified declaration.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getDeclObjCTypeEncoding(CXCursor C);
|
2010-05-15 05:29:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the spelling of a given CXTypeKind.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getTypeKindSpelling(enum CXTypeKind K);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the calling convention associated with a function type.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If a non-function type is passed in, CXCallingConv_Invalid is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXCallingConv clang_getFunctionTypeCallingConv(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-06-22 04:15:39 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-06-22 04:48:56 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the result type associated with a function type.
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If a non-function type is passed in, an invalid type is returned.
|
2010-06-22 04:15:39 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getResultType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-06-22 04:48:56 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the number of non-variadic arguments associated with a
|
|
|
|
* function type.
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2012-04-12 03:32:19 +08:00
|
|
|
* If a non-function type is passed in, -1 is returned.
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-04-12 03:32:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_getNumArgTypes(CXType T);
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the type of an argument of a function type.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* If a non-function type is passed in or the function does not have enough
|
|
|
|
* parameters, an invalid type is returned.
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getArgType(CXType T, unsigned i);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return 1 if the CXType is a variadic function type, and 0 otherwise.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isFunctionTypeVariadic(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the result type associated with a given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This only returns a valid type if the cursor refers to a function or method.
|
2010-06-22 04:48:56 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getCursorResultType(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-07-30 08:14:11 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return 1 if the CXType is a POD (plain old data) type, and 0
|
|
|
|
* otherwise.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isPODType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-12-07 06:05:01 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return the element type of an array, complex, or vector type.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If a type is passed in that is not an array, complex, or vector type,
|
|
|
|
* an invalid type is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getElementType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return the number of elements of an array or vector type.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If a type is passed in that is not an array or vector type,
|
|
|
|
* -1 is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE long long clang_getNumElements(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-09-28 01:44:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return the element type of an array type.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If a non-array type is passed in, an invalid type is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getArrayElementType(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-07-23 16:59:39 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Return the array size of a constant array.
|
2011-09-28 01:44:34 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If a non-array type is passed in, -1 is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE long long clang_getArraySize(CXType T);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-28 05:34:58 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns 1 if the base class specified by the cursor with kind
|
|
|
|
* CX_CXXBaseSpecifier is virtual.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isVirtualBase(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Represents the C++ access control level to a base class for a
|
|
|
|
* cursor with kind CX_CXXBaseSpecifier.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CX_CXXAccessSpecifier {
|
|
|
|
CX_CXXInvalidAccessSpecifier,
|
|
|
|
CX_CXXPublic,
|
|
|
|
CX_CXXProtected,
|
|
|
|
CX_CXXPrivate
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the access control level for the C++ base specifier
|
2011-10-01 01:58:23 +08:00
|
|
|
* represented by a cursor with kind CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier or
|
|
|
|
* CXCursor_AccessSpecifier.
|
2010-08-28 05:34:58 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CX_CXXAccessSpecifier clang_getCXXAccessSpecifier(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-09-14 06:52:57 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the number of overloaded declarations referenced by a
|
|
|
|
* \c CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param cursor The cursor whose overloaded declarations are being queried.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The number of overloaded declarations referenced by \c cursor. If it
|
|
|
|
* is not a \c CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef cursor, returns 0.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_getNumOverloadedDecls(CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a cursor for one of the overloaded declarations referenced
|
|
|
|
* by a \c CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param cursor The cursor whose overloaded declarations are being queried.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param index The zero-based index into the set of overloaded declarations in
|
|
|
|
* the cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns A cursor representing the declaration referenced by the given
|
|
|
|
* \c cursor at the specified \c index. If the cursor does not have an
|
|
|
|
* associated set of overloaded declarations, or if the index is out of bounds,
|
|
|
|
* returns \c clang_getNullCursor();
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getOverloadedDecl(CXCursor cursor,
|
|
|
|
unsigned index);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-26 09:42:22 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-08-28 05:34:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_ATTRIBUTES Information for attributes
|
2010-08-26 09:42:22 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief For cursors representing an iboutletcollection attribute,
|
|
|
|
* this function returns the collection element type.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXType clang_getIBOutletCollectionType(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_CURSOR_TRAVERSAL Traversing the AST with cursors
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* These routines provide the ability to traverse the abstract syntax tree
|
|
|
|
* using cursors.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes how the traversal of the children of a particular
|
|
|
|
* cursor should proceed after visiting a particular child cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A value of this enumeration type should be returned by each
|
|
|
|
* \c CXCursorVisitor to indicate how clang_visitChildren() proceed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXChildVisitResult {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Terminates the cursor traversal.
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXChildVisit_Break,
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Continues the cursor traversal with the next sibling of
|
|
|
|
* the cursor just visited, without visiting its children.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXChildVisit_Continue,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Recursively traverse the children of this cursor, using
|
|
|
|
* the same visitor and client data.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXChildVisit_Recurse
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Visitor invoked for each cursor found by a traversal.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This visitor function will be invoked for each cursor found by
|
|
|
|
* clang_visitCursorChildren(). Its first argument is the cursor being
|
|
|
|
* visited, its second argument is the parent visitor for that cursor,
|
|
|
|
* and its third argument is the client data provided to
|
|
|
|
* clang_visitCursorChildren().
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The visitor should return one of the \c CXChildVisitResult values
|
|
|
|
* to direct clang_visitCursorChildren().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef enum CXChildVisitResult (*CXCursorVisitor)(CXCursor cursor,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor parent,
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXClientData client_data);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Visit the children of a particular cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This function visits all the direct children of the given cursor,
|
|
|
|
* invoking the given \p visitor function with the cursors of each
|
|
|
|
* visited child. The traversal may be recursive, if the visitor returns
|
|
|
|
* \c CXChildVisit_Recurse. The traversal may also be ended prematurely, if
|
|
|
|
* the visitor returns \c CXChildVisit_Break.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param parent the cursor whose child may be visited. All kinds of
|
2010-01-24 12:10:31 +08:00
|
|
|
* cursors can be visited, including invalid cursors (which, by
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* definition, have no children).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param visitor the visitor function that will be invoked for each
|
|
|
|
* child of \p parent.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param client_data pointer data supplied by the client, which will
|
|
|
|
* be passed to the visitor each time it is invoked.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns a non-zero value if the traversal was terminated
|
|
|
|
* prematurely by the visitor returning \c CXChildVisit_Break.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_visitChildren(CXCursor parent,
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursorVisitor visitor,
|
|
|
|
CXClientData client_data);
|
2010-11-03 22:12:26 +08:00
|
|
|
#ifdef __has_feature
|
|
|
|
# if __has_feature(blocks)
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Visitor invoked for each cursor found by a traversal.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This visitor block will be invoked for each cursor found by
|
|
|
|
* clang_visitChildrenWithBlock(). Its first argument is the cursor being
|
|
|
|
* visited, its second argument is the parent visitor for that cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The visitor should return one of the \c CXChildVisitResult values
|
|
|
|
* to direct clang_visitChildrenWithBlock().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef enum CXChildVisitResult
|
|
|
|
(^CXCursorVisitorBlock)(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* Visits the children of a cursor using the specified block. Behaves
|
|
|
|
* identically to clang_visitChildren() in all other respects.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_visitChildrenWithBlock(CXCursor parent,
|
|
|
|
CXCursorVisitorBlock block);
|
|
|
|
# endif
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_CURSOR_XREF Cross-referencing in the AST
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* These routines provide the ability to determine references within and
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* across translation units, by providing the names of the entities referenced
|
|
|
|
* by cursors, follow reference cursors to the declarations they reference,
|
|
|
|
* and associate declarations with their definitions.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a Unified Symbol Resolution (USR) for the entity referenced
|
|
|
|
* by the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A Unified Symbol Resolution (USR) is a string that identifies a particular
|
|
|
|
* entity (function, class, variable, etc.) within a program. USRs can be
|
|
|
|
* compared across translation units to determine, e.g., when references in
|
|
|
|
* one translation refer to an entity defined in another translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getCursorUSR(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Construct a USR for a specified Objective-C class.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_constructUSR_ObjCClass(const char *class_name);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Construct a USR for a specified Objective-C category.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString
|
2010-03-16 01:38:58 +08:00
|
|
|
clang_constructUSR_ObjCCategory(const char *class_name,
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
const char *category_name);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Construct a USR for a specified Objective-C protocol.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString
|
|
|
|
clang_constructUSR_ObjCProtocol(const char *protocol_name);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Construct a USR for a specified Objective-C instance variable and
|
|
|
|
* the USR for its containing class.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_constructUSR_ObjCIvar(const char *name,
|
|
|
|
CXString classUSR);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Construct a USR for a specified Objective-C method and
|
|
|
|
* the USR for its containing class.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_constructUSR_ObjCMethod(const char *name,
|
|
|
|
unsigned isInstanceMethod,
|
|
|
|
CXString classUSR);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Construct a USR for a specified Objective-C property and the USR
|
|
|
|
* for its containing class.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_constructUSR_ObjCProperty(const char *property,
|
|
|
|
CXString classUSR);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a name for the entity referenced by this cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getCursorSpelling(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-03-31 04:58:35 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a range for a piece that forms the cursors spelling name.
|
|
|
|
* Most of the times there is only one range for the complete spelling but for
|
|
|
|
* objc methods and objc message expressions, there are multiple pieces for each
|
|
|
|
* selector identifier.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param pieceIndex the index of the spelling name piece. If this is greater
|
|
|
|
* than the actual number of pieces, it will return a NULL (invalid) range.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param options Reserved.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceRange clang_Cursor_getSpellingNameRange(CXCursor,
|
|
|
|
unsigned pieceIndex,
|
|
|
|
unsigned options);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-10-03 06:49:11 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the display name for the entity referenced by this cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The display name contains extra information that helps identify the cursor,
|
|
|
|
* such as the parameters of a function or template or the arguments of a
|
|
|
|
* class template specialization.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getCursorDisplayName(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-19 09:20:04 +08:00
|
|
|
/** \brief For a cursor that is a reference, retrieve a cursor representing the
|
|
|
|
* entity that it references.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Reference cursors refer to other entities in the AST. For example, an
|
|
|
|
* Objective-C superclass reference cursor refers to an Objective-C class.
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* This function produces the cursor for the Objective-C class from the
|
2010-01-19 09:20:04 +08:00
|
|
|
* cursor for the superclass reference. If the input cursor is a declaration or
|
|
|
|
* definition, it returns that declaration or definition unchanged.
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* Otherwise, returns the NULL cursor.
|
2010-01-19 09:20:04 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getCursorReferenced(CXCursor);
|
2010-01-20 03:34:47 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-20 03:34:47 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief For a cursor that is either a reference to or a declaration
|
|
|
|
* of some entity, retrieve a cursor that describes the definition of
|
|
|
|
* that entity.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Some entities can be declared multiple times within a translation
|
|
|
|
* unit, but only one of those declarations can also be a
|
|
|
|
* definition. For example, given:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* int f(int, int);
|
|
|
|
* int g(int x, int y) { return f(x, y); }
|
|
|
|
* int f(int a, int b) { return a + b; }
|
|
|
|
* int f(int, int);
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* there are three declarations of the function "f", but only the
|
|
|
|
* second one is a definition. The clang_getCursorDefinition()
|
|
|
|
* function will take any cursor pointing to a declaration of "f"
|
|
|
|
* (the first or fourth lines of the example) or a cursor referenced
|
|
|
|
* that uses "f" (the call to "f' inside "g") and will return a
|
|
|
|
* declaration cursor pointing to the definition (the second "f"
|
|
|
|
* declaration).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If given a cursor for which there is no corresponding definition,
|
|
|
|
* e.g., because there is no definition of that entity within this
|
|
|
|
* translation unit, returns a NULL cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getCursorDefinition(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-20 03:34:47 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine whether the declaration pointed to by this cursor
|
|
|
|
* is also a definition of that entity.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_isCursorDefinition(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-11-20 07:44:15 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the canonical cursor corresponding to the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* In the C family of languages, many kinds of entities can be declared several
|
|
|
|
* times within a single translation unit. For example, a structure type can
|
|
|
|
* be forward-declared (possibly multiple times) and later defined:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* struct X;
|
|
|
|
* struct X;
|
|
|
|
* struct X {
|
|
|
|
* int member;
|
|
|
|
* };
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The declarations and the definition of \c X are represented by three
|
|
|
|
* different cursors, all of which are declarations of the same underlying
|
|
|
|
* entity. One of these cursor is considered the "canonical" cursor, which
|
|
|
|
* is effectively the representative for the underlying entity. One can
|
|
|
|
* determine if two cursors are declarations of the same underlying entity by
|
|
|
|
* comparing their canonical cursors.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The canonical cursor for the entity referred to by the given cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getCanonicalCursor(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-03-31 06:15:48 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief If the cursor points to a selector identifier in a objc method or
|
|
|
|
* message expression, this returns the selector index.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* After getting a cursor with #clang_getCursor, this can be called to
|
2012-03-31 06:15:48 +08:00
|
|
|
* determine if the location points to a selector identifier.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The selector index if the cursor is an objc method or message
|
|
|
|
* expression and the cursor is pointing to a selector identifier, or -1
|
|
|
|
* otherwise.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_Cursor_getObjCSelectorIndex(CXCursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-07-03 07:54:36 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Given a cursor pointing to a C++ method call or an ObjC message,
|
|
|
|
* returns non-zero if the method/message is "dynamic", meaning:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For a C++ method: the call is virtual.
|
|
|
|
* For an ObjC message: the receiver is an object instance, not 'super' or a
|
|
|
|
* specific class.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If the method/message is "static" or the cursor does not point to a
|
|
|
|
* method/message, it will return zero.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_Cursor_isDynamicCall(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-20 08:34:58 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Given a cursor that represents a declaration, return the associated
|
|
|
|
* comment's source range. The range may include multiple consecutive comments
|
|
|
|
* with whitespace in between.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceRange clang_Cursor_getCommentRange(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Given a cursor that represents a declaration, return the associated
|
|
|
|
* comment text, including comment markers.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_Cursor_getRawCommentText(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-27 04:39:18 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Given a cursor that represents a documentable entity (e.g.,
|
|
|
|
* declaration), return the associated \\brief paragraph; otherwise return the
|
|
|
|
* first paragraph.
|
2012-06-27 04:39:18 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_Cursor_getBriefCommentText(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Given a cursor that represents a documentable entity (e.g.,
|
|
|
|
* declaration), return the associated parsed comment as a
|
|
|
|
* \c CXComment_FullComment AST node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXComment clang_Cursor_getParsedComment(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_COMMENT Comment AST introspection
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The routines in this group provide access to information in the
|
|
|
|
* documentation comment ASTs.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes the type of the comment AST node (\c CXComment). A comment
|
|
|
|
* node can be considered block content (e. g., paragraph), inline content
|
|
|
|
* (plain text) or neither (the root AST node).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCommentKind {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Null comment. No AST node is constructed at the requested location
|
|
|
|
* because there is no text or a syntax error.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_Null = 0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Plain text. Inline content.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_Text = 1,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A command with word-like arguments that is considered inline content.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example: \\c command.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_InlineCommand = 2,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief HTML start tag with attributes (name-value pairs). Considered
|
|
|
|
* inline content.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example:
|
|
|
|
* \verbatim
|
|
|
|
* <br> <br /> <a href="http://example.org/">
|
|
|
|
* \endverbatim
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_HTMLStartTag = 3,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief HTML end tag. Considered inline content.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example:
|
|
|
|
* \verbatim
|
|
|
|
* </a>
|
|
|
|
* \endverbatim
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_HTMLEndTag = 4,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A paragraph, contains inline comment. The paragraph itself is
|
|
|
|
* block content.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_Paragraph = 5,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A command that has zero or more word-like arguments (number of
|
|
|
|
* word-like arguments depends on command name) and a paragraph as an
|
|
|
|
* argument. Block command is block content.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Paragraph argument is also a child of the block command.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example: \\brief has 0 word-like arguments and a paragraph argument.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* AST nodes of special kinds that parser knows about (e. g., \\param
|
|
|
|
* command) have their own node kinds.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_BlockCommand = 6,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A \\param or \\arg command that describes the function parameter
|
|
|
|
* (name, passing direction, description).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \brief For example: \\param [in] ParamName description.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_ParamCommand = 7,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-08-01 06:37:06 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A \\tparam command that describes a template parameter (name and
|
|
|
|
* description).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \brief For example: \\tparam T description.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXComment_TParamCommand = 8,
|
|
|
|
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A verbatim block command (e. g., preformatted code). Verbatim
|
|
|
|
* block has an opening and a closing command and contains multiple lines of
|
|
|
|
* text (\c CXComment_VerbatimBlockLine child nodes).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example:
|
|
|
|
* \\verbatim
|
|
|
|
* aaa
|
|
|
|
* \\endverbatim
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-08-01 06:37:06 +08:00
|
|
|
CXComment_VerbatimBlockCommand = 9,
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A line of text that is contained within a
|
|
|
|
* CXComment_VerbatimBlockCommand node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-08-01 06:37:06 +08:00
|
|
|
CXComment_VerbatimBlockLine = 10,
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A verbatim line command. Verbatim line has an opening command,
|
|
|
|
* a single line of text (up to the newline after the opening command) and
|
|
|
|
* has no closing command.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-08-01 06:37:06 +08:00
|
|
|
CXComment_VerbatimLine = 11,
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A full comment attached to a declaration, contains block content.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-08-01 06:37:06 +08:00
|
|
|
CXComment_FullComment = 12
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
2012-07-24 00:43:01 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The most appropriate rendering mode for an inline command, chosen on
|
|
|
|
* command semantics in Doxygen.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCommentInlineCommandRenderKind {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Command argument should be rendered in a normal font.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCommentInlineCommandRenderKind_Normal,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Command argument should be rendered in a bold font.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCommentInlineCommandRenderKind_Bold,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Command argument should be rendered in a monospaced font.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCommentInlineCommandRenderKind_Monospaced,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Command argument should be rendered emphasized (typically italic
|
|
|
|
* font).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCommentInlineCommandRenderKind_Emphasized
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes parameter passing direction for \\param or \\arg command.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCommentParamPassDirection {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The parameter is an input parameter.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCommentParamPassDirection_In,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The parameter is an output parameter.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCommentParamPassDirection_Out,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The parameter is an input and output parameter.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCommentParamPassDirection_InOut
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment AST node of any kind.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the type of the AST node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXCommentKind clang_Comment_getKind(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment AST node of any kind.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns number of children of the AST node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_Comment_getNumChildren(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment AST node of any kind.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param ArgIdx argument index (zero-based).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the specified child of the AST node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXComment clang_Comment_getChild(CXComment Comment, unsigned ChildIdx);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A \c CXComment_Paragraph node is considered whitespace if it contains
|
|
|
|
* only \c CXComment_Text nodes that are empty or whitespace.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Other AST nodes (except \c CXComment_Paragraph and \c CXComment_Text) are
|
|
|
|
* never considered whitespace.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if \c Comment is whitespace.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_Comment_isWhitespace(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if \c Comment is inline content and has a newline
|
|
|
|
* immediately following it in the comment text. Newlines between paragraphs
|
|
|
|
* do not count.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_InlineContentComment_hasTrailingNewline(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_Text AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns text contained in the AST node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_TextComment_getText(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_InlineCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns name of the inline command.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_InlineCommandComment_getCommandName(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-07-24 00:43:01 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_InlineCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the most appropriate rendering mode, chosen on command
|
|
|
|
* semantics in Doxygen.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXCommentInlineCommandRenderKind
|
|
|
|
clang_InlineCommandComment_getRenderKind(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_InlineCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns number of command arguments.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_InlineCommandComment_getNumArgs(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_InlineCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param ArgIdx argument index (zero-based).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns text of the specified argument.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_InlineCommandComment_getArgText(CXComment Comment,
|
|
|
|
unsigned ArgIdx);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_HTMLStartTag or \c CXComment_HTMLEndTag AST
|
|
|
|
* node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns HTML tag name.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_HTMLTagComment_getTagName(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_HTMLStartTag AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if tag is self-closing (for example, <br />).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_HTMLStartTagComment_isSelfClosing(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_HTMLStartTag AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns number of attributes (name-value pairs) attached to the start tag.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_HTMLStartTag_getNumAttrs(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_HTMLStartTag AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param AttrIdx attribute index (zero-based).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns name of the specified attribute.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_HTMLStartTag_getAttrName(CXComment Comment, unsigned AttrIdx);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_HTMLStartTag AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param AttrIdx attribute index (zero-based).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns value of the specified attribute.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_HTMLStartTag_getAttrValue(CXComment Comment, unsigned AttrIdx);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_BlockCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns name of the block command.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_BlockCommandComment_getCommandName(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_BlockCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns number of word-like arguments.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_BlockCommandComment_getNumArgs(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_BlockCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param ArgIdx argument index (zero-based).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns text of the specified word-like argument.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_BlockCommandComment_getArgText(CXComment Comment,
|
|
|
|
unsigned ArgIdx);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_BlockCommand or
|
|
|
|
* \c CXComment_VerbatimBlockCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns paragraph argument of the block command.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXComment clang_BlockCommandComment_getParagraph(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_ParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns parameter name.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_ParamCommandComment_getParamName(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_ParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if the parameter that this AST node represents was found
|
|
|
|
* in the function prototype and \c clang_ParamCommandComment_getParamIndex
|
|
|
|
* function will return a meaningful value.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_ParamCommandComment_isParamIndexValid(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_ParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns zero-based parameter index in function prototype.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_ParamCommandComment_getParamIndex(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_ParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if parameter passing direction was specified explicitly in
|
|
|
|
* the comment.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_ParamCommandComment_isDirectionExplicit(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_ParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns parameter passing direction.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
enum CXCommentParamPassDirection clang_ParamCommandComment_getDirection(
|
|
|
|
CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-08-01 06:37:06 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_TParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns template parameter name.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_TParamCommandComment_getParamName(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_TParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns non-zero if the parameter that this AST node represents was found
|
|
|
|
* in the template parameter list and
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_TParamCommandComment_getDepth and
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_TParamCommandComment_getIndex functions will return a meaningful
|
|
|
|
* value.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_TParamCommandComment_isParamPositionValid(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_TParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns zero-based nesting depth of this parameter in the template parameter list.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example,
|
|
|
|
* \verbatim
|
|
|
|
* template<typename C, template<typename T> class TT>
|
|
|
|
* void test(TT<int> aaa);
|
|
|
|
* \endverbatim
|
|
|
|
* for C and TT nesting depth is 0,
|
|
|
|
* for T nesting depth is 1.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_TParamCommandComment_getDepth(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_TParamCommand AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns zero-based parameter index in the template parameter list at a
|
|
|
|
* given nesting depth.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For example,
|
|
|
|
* \verbatim
|
|
|
|
* template<typename C, template<typename T> class TT>
|
|
|
|
* void test(TT<int> aaa);
|
|
|
|
* \endverbatim
|
|
|
|
* for C and TT nesting depth is 0, so we can ask for index at depth 0:
|
|
|
|
* at depth 0 C's index is 0, TT's index is 1.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For T nesting depth is 1, so we can ask for index at depth 0 and 1:
|
|
|
|
* at depth 0 T's index is 1 (same as TT's),
|
|
|
|
* at depth 1 T's index is 0.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned clang_TParamCommandComment_getIndex(CXComment Comment, unsigned Depth);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_VerbatimBlockLine AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns text contained in the AST node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_VerbatimBlockLineComment_getText(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_VerbatimLine AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns text contained in the AST node.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_VerbatimLineComment_getText(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Convert an HTML tag AST node to string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_HTMLStartTag or \c CXComment_HTMLEndTag AST
|
|
|
|
* node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns string containing an HTML tag.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_HTMLTagComment_getAsString(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Convert a given full parsed comment to an HTML fragment.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Specific details of HTML layout are subject to change. Don't try to parse
|
|
|
|
* this HTML back into an AST, use other APIs instead.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Currently the following CSS classes are used:
|
|
|
|
* \li "para-brief" for \\brief paragraph and equivalent commands;
|
|
|
|
* \li "para-returns" for \\returns paragraph and equivalent commands;
|
|
|
|
* \li "word-returns" for the "Returns" word in \\returns paragraph.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-07-21 09:47:43 +08:00
|
|
|
* Function argument documentation is rendered as a \<dl\> list with arguments
|
|
|
|
* sorted in function prototype order. CSS classes used:
|
|
|
|
* \li "param-name-index-NUMBER" for parameter name (\<dt\>);
|
|
|
|
* \li "param-descr-index-NUMBER" for parameter description (\<dd\>);
|
|
|
|
* \li "param-name-index-invalid" and "param-descr-index-invalid" are used if
|
|
|
|
* parameter index is invalid.
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2012-08-01 06:37:06 +08:00
|
|
|
* Template parameter documentation is rendered as a \<dl\> list with
|
|
|
|
* parameters sorted in template parameter list order. CSS classes used:
|
|
|
|
* \li "tparam-name-index-NUMBER" for parameter name (\<dt\>);
|
|
|
|
* \li "tparam-descr-index-NUMBER" for parameter description (\<dd\>);
|
|
|
|
* \li "taram-name-index-other" and "tparam-descr-index-other" are used for
|
|
|
|
* names inside template template parameters;
|
|
|
|
* \li "tparam-name-index-invalid" and "tparam-descr-index-invalid" are used if
|
|
|
|
* parameter position is invalid.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-07-21 05:34:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Comment a \c CXComment_FullComment AST node.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns string containing an HTML fragment.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_FullComment_getAsHTML(CXComment Comment);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-05-18 04:06:56 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_CPP C++ AST introspection
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The routines in this group provide access information in the ASTs specific
|
|
|
|
* to C++ language features.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-09-01 06:12:17 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Determine if a C++ member function or member function template is
|
|
|
|
* declared 'static'.
|
2010-05-18 04:06:56 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isStatic(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-05-12 23:17:24 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine if a C++ member function or member function template is
|
|
|
|
* explicitly declared 'virtual' or if it overrides a virtual method from
|
|
|
|
* one of the base classes.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isVirtual(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-09-01 06:12:17 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Given a cursor that represents a template, determine
|
|
|
|
* the cursor kind of the specializations would be generated by instantiating
|
|
|
|
* the template.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This routine can be used to determine what flavor of function template,
|
|
|
|
* class template, or class template partial specialization is stored in the
|
|
|
|
* cursor. For example, it can describe whether a class template cursor is
|
|
|
|
* declared with "struct", "class" or "union".
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param C The cursor to query. This cursor should represent a template
|
|
|
|
* declaration.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The cursor kind of the specializations that would be generated
|
|
|
|
* by instantiating the template \p C. If \p C is not a template, returns
|
|
|
|
* \c CXCursor_NoDeclFound.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXCursorKind clang_getTemplateCursorKind(CXCursor C);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-09-02 08:07:54 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Given a cursor that may represent a specialization or instantiation
|
|
|
|
* of a template, retrieve the cursor that represents the template that it
|
|
|
|
* specializes or from which it was instantiated.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This routine determines the template involved both for explicit
|
|
|
|
* specializations of templates and for implicit instantiations of the template,
|
|
|
|
* both of which are referred to as "specializations". For a class template
|
|
|
|
* specialization (e.g., \c std::vector<bool>), this routine will return
|
|
|
|
* either the primary template (\c std::vector) or, if the specialization was
|
|
|
|
* instantiated from a class template partial specialization, the class template
|
|
|
|
* partial specialization. For a class template partial specialization and a
|
|
|
|
* function template specialization (including instantiations), this
|
|
|
|
* this routine will return the specialized template.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* For members of a class template (e.g., member functions, member classes, or
|
|
|
|
* static data members), returns the specialized or instantiated member.
|
|
|
|
* Although not strictly "templates" in the C++ language, members of class
|
|
|
|
* templates have the same notions of specializations and instantiations that
|
|
|
|
* templates do, so this routine treats them similarly.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param C A cursor that may be a specialization of a template or a member
|
|
|
|
* of a template.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns If the given cursor is a specialization or instantiation of a
|
|
|
|
* template or a member thereof, the template or member that it specializes or
|
|
|
|
* from which it was instantiated. Otherwise, returns a NULL cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCursor clang_getSpecializedCursorTemplate(CXCursor C);
|
2011-07-26 01:48:11 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Given a cursor that references something else, return the source range
|
|
|
|
* covering that reference.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param C A cursor pointing to a member reference, a declaration reference, or
|
|
|
|
* an operator call.
|
|
|
|
* \param NameFlags A bitset with three independent flags:
|
|
|
|
* CXNameRange_WantQualifier, CXNameRange_WantTemplateArgs, and
|
|
|
|
* CXNameRange_WantSinglePiece.
|
|
|
|
* \param PieceIndex For contiguous names or when passing the flag
|
|
|
|
* CXNameRange_WantSinglePiece, only one piece with index 0 is
|
|
|
|
* available. When the CXNameRange_WantSinglePiece flag is not passed for a
|
2012-06-02 18:20:41 +08:00
|
|
|
* non-contiguous names, this index can be used to retrieve the individual
|
2011-07-26 01:48:11 +08:00
|
|
|
* pieces of the name. See also CXNameRange_WantSinglePiece.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The piece of the name pointed to by the given cursor. If there is no
|
|
|
|
* name, or if the PieceIndex is out-of-range, a null-cursor will be returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-07-26 06:00:44 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceRange clang_getCursorReferenceNameRange(CXCursor C,
|
|
|
|
unsigned NameFlags,
|
2011-07-26 01:48:11 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned PieceIndex);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
enum CXNameRefFlags {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Include the nested-name-specifier, e.g. Foo:: in x.Foo::y, in the
|
|
|
|
* range.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXNameRange_WantQualifier = 0x1,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Include the explicit template arguments, e.g. \<int> in x.f<int>,
|
|
|
|
* in the range.
|
2011-07-26 01:48:11 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXNameRange_WantTemplateArgs = 0x2,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief If the name is non-contiguous, return the full spanning range.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Non-contiguous names occur in Objective-C when a selector with two or more
|
|
|
|
* parameters is used, or in C++ when using an operator:
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* [object doSomething:here withValue:there]; // ObjC
|
|
|
|
* return some_vector[1]; // C++
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXNameRange_WantSinglePiece = 0x4
|
|
|
|
};
|
2010-09-02 08:07:54 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-27 02:31:56 +08:00
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_LEX Token extraction and manipulation
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The routines in this group provide access to the tokens within a
|
|
|
|
* translation unit, along with a semantic mapping of those tokens to
|
|
|
|
* their corresponding cursors.
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes a kind of token.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef enum CXTokenKind {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A token that contains some kind of punctuation.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXToken_Punctuation,
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-27 02:31:56 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief A language keyword.
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXToken_Keyword,
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An identifier (that is not a keyword).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXToken_Identifier,
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A numeric, string, or character literal.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXToken_Literal,
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A comment.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXToken_Comment
|
|
|
|
} CXTokenKind;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes a single preprocessing token.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
unsigned int_data[4];
|
|
|
|
void *ptr_data;
|
|
|
|
} CXToken;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the kind of the given token.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXTokenKind clang_getTokenKind(CXToken);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the spelling of the given token.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The spelling of a token is the textual representation of that token, e.g.,
|
|
|
|
* the text of an identifier or keyword.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getTokenSpelling(CXTranslationUnit, CXToken);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the source location of the given token.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceLocation clang_getTokenLocation(CXTranslationUnit,
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
CXToken);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a source range that covers the given token.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXSourceRange clang_getTokenExtent(CXTranslationUnit, CXToken);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Tokenize the source code described by the given range into raw
|
|
|
|
* lexical tokens.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param TU the translation unit whose text is being tokenized.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Range the source range in which text should be tokenized. All of the
|
|
|
|
* tokens produced by tokenization will fall within this source range,
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Tokens this pointer will be set to point to the array of tokens
|
|
|
|
* that occur within the given source range. The returned pointer must be
|
|
|
|
* freed with clang_disposeTokens() before the translation unit is destroyed.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param NumTokens will be set to the number of tokens in the \c *Tokens
|
|
|
|
* array.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_tokenize(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXSourceRange Range,
|
|
|
|
CXToken **Tokens, unsigned *NumTokens);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Annotate the given set of tokens by providing cursors for each token
|
|
|
|
* that can be mapped to a specific entity within the abstract syntax tree.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-27 02:31:56 +08:00
|
|
|
* This token-annotation routine is equivalent to invoking
|
|
|
|
* clang_getCursor() for the source locations of each of the
|
|
|
|
* tokens. The cursors provided are filtered, so that only those
|
|
|
|
* cursors that have a direct correspondence to the token are
|
|
|
|
* accepted. For example, given a function call \c f(x),
|
|
|
|
* clang_getCursor() would provide the following cursors:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* * when the cursor is over the 'f', a DeclRefExpr cursor referring to 'f'.
|
|
|
|
* * when the cursor is over the '(' or the ')', a CallExpr referring to 'f'.
|
|
|
|
* * when the cursor is over the 'x', a DeclRefExpr cursor referring to 'x'.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Only the first and last of these cursors will occur within the
|
|
|
|
* annotate, since the tokens "f" and "x' directly refer to a function
|
|
|
|
* and a variable, respectively, but the parentheses are just a small
|
|
|
|
* part of the full syntax of the function call expression, which is
|
|
|
|
* not provided as an annotation.
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param TU the translation unit that owns the given tokens.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Tokens the set of tokens to annotate.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param NumTokens the number of tokens in \p Tokens.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Cursors an array of \p NumTokens cursors, whose contents will be
|
|
|
|
* replaced with the cursors corresponding to each token.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_annotateTokens(CXTranslationUnit TU,
|
|
|
|
CXToken *Tokens, unsigned NumTokens,
|
|
|
|
CXCursor *Cursors);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Free the given set of tokens.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_disposeTokens(CXTranslationUnit TU,
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
CXToken *Tokens, unsigned NumTokens);
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 01:06:03 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_DEBUG Debugging facilities
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* These routines are used for testing and debugging, only, and should not
|
|
|
|
* be relied upon.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-09-24 01:52:52 +08:00
|
|
|
/* for debug/testing */
|
2010-02-17 08:41:32 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getCursorKindSpelling(enum CXCursorKind Kind);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_getDefinitionSpellingAndExtent(CXCursor,
|
|
|
|
const char **startBuf,
|
2009-09-24 01:52:52 +08:00
|
|
|
const char **endBuf,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *startLine,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *startColumn,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *endLine,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *endColumn);
|
2010-02-19 07:07:20 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_enableStackTraces(void);
|
2010-11-04 09:26:29 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_executeOnThread(void (*fn)(void*), void *user_data,
|
|
|
|
unsigned stack_size);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_CODE_COMPLET Code completion
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Code completion involves taking an (incomplete) source file, along with
|
|
|
|
* knowledge of where the user is actively editing that file, and suggesting
|
|
|
|
* syntactically- and semantically-valid constructs that the user might want to
|
|
|
|
* use at that particular point in the source code. These data structures and
|
|
|
|
* routines provide support for code completion.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A semantic string that describes a code-completion result.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A semantic string that describes the formatting of a code-completion
|
|
|
|
* result as a single "template" of text that should be inserted into the
|
|
|
|
* source buffer when a particular code-completion result is selected.
|
|
|
|
* Each semantic string is made up of some number of "chunks", each of which
|
|
|
|
* contains some text along with a description of what that text means, e.g.,
|
|
|
|
* the name of the entity being referenced, whether the text chunk is part of
|
|
|
|
* the template, or whether it is a "placeholder" that the user should replace
|
|
|
|
* with actual code,of a specific kind. See \c CXCompletionChunkKind for a
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* description of the different kinds of chunks.
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void *CXCompletionString;
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A single result of code completion.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief The kind of entity that this completion refers to.
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* The cursor kind will be a macro, keyword, or a declaration (one of the
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* *Decl cursor kinds), describing the entity that the completion is
|
|
|
|
* referring to.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \todo In the future, we would like to provide a full cursor, to allow
|
|
|
|
* the client to extract additional information from declaration.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCursorKind CursorKind;
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief The code-completion string that describes how to insert this
|
|
|
|
* code-completion result into the editing buffer.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionString CompletionString;
|
|
|
|
} CXCompletionResult;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Describes a single piece of text within a code-completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* Each "chunk" within a code-completion string (\c CXCompletionString) is
|
|
|
|
* either a piece of text with a specific "kind" that describes how that text
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* should be interpreted by the client or is another completion string.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCompletionChunkKind {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A code-completion string that describes "optional" text that
|
|
|
|
* could be a part of the template (but is not required).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The Optional chunk is the only kind of chunk that has a code-completion
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* string for its representation, which is accessible via
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* \c clang_getCompletionChunkCompletionString(). The code-completion string
|
|
|
|
* describes an additional part of the template that is completely optional.
|
|
|
|
* For example, optional chunks can be used to describe the placeholders for
|
|
|
|
* arguments that match up with defaulted function parameters, e.g. given:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* void f(int x, float y = 3.14, double z = 2.71828);
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The code-completion string for this function would contain:
|
|
|
|
* - a TypedText chunk for "f".
|
|
|
|
* - a LeftParen chunk for "(".
|
|
|
|
* - a Placeholder chunk for "int x"
|
|
|
|
* - an Optional chunk containing the remaining defaulted arguments, e.g.,
|
|
|
|
* - a Comma chunk for ","
|
2010-02-17 16:07:44 +08:00
|
|
|
* - a Placeholder chunk for "float y"
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* - an Optional chunk containing the last defaulted argument:
|
|
|
|
* - a Comma chunk for ","
|
|
|
|
* - a Placeholder chunk for "double z"
|
|
|
|
* - a RightParen chunk for ")"
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-02-17 16:07:44 +08:00
|
|
|
* There are many ways to handle Optional chunks. Two simple approaches are:
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* - Completely ignore optional chunks, in which case the template for the
|
|
|
|
* function "f" would only include the first parameter ("int x").
|
|
|
|
* - Fully expand all optional chunks, in which case the template for the
|
|
|
|
* function "f" would have all of the parameters.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_Optional,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Text that a user would be expected to type to get this
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* code-completion result.
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* There will be exactly one "typed text" chunk in a semantic string, which
|
|
|
|
* will typically provide the spelling of a keyword or the name of a
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* declaration that could be used at the current code point. Clients are
|
|
|
|
* expected to filter the code-completion results based on the text in this
|
|
|
|
* chunk.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_TypedText,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Text that should be inserted as part of a code-completion result.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A "text" chunk represents text that is part of the template to be
|
|
|
|
* inserted into user code should this particular code-completion result
|
|
|
|
* be selected.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_Text,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Placeholder text that should be replaced by the user.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A "placeholder" chunk marks a place where the user should insert text
|
|
|
|
* into the code-completion template. For example, placeholders might mark
|
|
|
|
* the function parameters for a function declaration, to indicate that the
|
|
|
|
* user should provide arguments for each of those parameters. The actual
|
|
|
|
* text in a placeholder is a suggestion for the text to display before
|
|
|
|
* the user replaces the placeholder with real code.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_Placeholder,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Informative text that should be displayed but never inserted as
|
|
|
|
* part of the template.
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* An "informative" chunk contains annotations that can be displayed to
|
|
|
|
* help the user decide whether a particular code-completion result is the
|
|
|
|
* right option, but which is not part of the actual template to be inserted
|
|
|
|
* by code completion.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_Informative,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Text that describes the current parameter when code-completion is
|
|
|
|
* referring to function call, message send, or template specialization.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* A "current parameter" chunk occurs when code-completion is providing
|
|
|
|
* information about a parameter corresponding to the argument at the
|
|
|
|
* code-completion point. For example, given a function
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* int add(int x, int y);
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* and the source code \c add(, where the code-completion point is after the
|
|
|
|
* "(", the code-completion string will contain a "current parameter" chunk
|
|
|
|
* for "int x", indicating that the current argument will initialize that
|
|
|
|
* parameter. After typing further, to \c add(17, (where the code-completion
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* point is after the ","), the code-completion string will contain a
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* "current paremeter" chunk to "int y".
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_CurrentParameter,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A left parenthesis ('('), used to initiate a function call or
|
|
|
|
* signal the beginning of a function parameter list.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_LeftParen,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A right parenthesis (')'), used to finish a function call or
|
|
|
|
* signal the end of a function parameter list.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_RightParen,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A left bracket ('[').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_LeftBracket,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A right bracket (']').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_RightBracket,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A left brace ('{').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_LeftBrace,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A right brace ('}').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_RightBrace,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A left angle bracket ('<').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_LeftAngle,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A right angle bracket ('>').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_RightAngle,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A comma separator (',').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2009-12-19 02:53:37 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_Comma,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Text that specifies the result type of a given result.
|
2009-12-19 02:53:37 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This special kind of informative chunk is not meant to be inserted into
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* the text buffer. Rather, it is meant to illustrate the type that an
|
2009-12-19 02:53:37 +08:00
|
|
|
* expression using the given completion string would have.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
Improve code completion by introducing patterns for the various C and
C++ grammatical constructs that show up in top-level (namespace-level)
declarations, member declarations, template declarations, statements,
expressions, conditions, etc. For example, we now provide a pattern
for
static_cast<type>(expr)
when we can have an expression, or
using namespace identifier;
when we can have a using directive.
Also, improves the results of code completion at the beginning of a
top-level declaration. Previously, we would see value names (function
names, global variables, etc.); now we see types, namespace names,
etc., but no values.
llvm-svn: 93134
2010-01-11 07:08:15 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_ResultType,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A colon (':').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_Colon,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A semicolon (';').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_SemiColon,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An '=' sign.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_Equal,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* Horizontal space (' ').
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_HorizontalSpace,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* Vertical space ('\n'), after which it is generally a good idea to
|
|
|
|
* perform indentation.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionChunk_VerticalSpace
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the kind of a particular chunk within a completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param completion_string the completion string to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param chunk_number the 0-based index of the chunk in the completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the kind of the chunk at the index \c chunk_number.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXCompletionChunkKind
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionChunkKind(CXCompletionString completion_string,
|
|
|
|
unsigned chunk_number);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the text associated with a particular chunk within a
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param completion_string the completion string to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param chunk_number the 0-based index of the chunk in the completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the text associated with the chunk at index \c chunk_number.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-02-17 09:42:24 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionChunkText(CXCompletionString completion_string,
|
|
|
|
unsigned chunk_number);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the completion string associated with a particular chunk
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
* within a completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param completion_string the completion string to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param chunk_number the 0-based index of the chunk in the completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the completion string associated with the chunk at index
|
2011-10-14 23:31:08 +08:00
|
|
|
* \c chunk_number.
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCompletionString
|
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionChunkCompletionString(CXCompletionString completion_string,
|
|
|
|
unsigned chunk_number);
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the number of chunks in the given code-completion string.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned
|
|
|
|
clang_getNumCompletionChunks(CXCompletionString completion_string);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-05-27 06:00:08 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the priority of this code completion.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The priority of a code completion indicates how likely it is that this
|
|
|
|
* particular completion is the completion that the user will select. The
|
|
|
|
* priority is selected by various internal heuristics.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param completion_string The completion string to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The priority of this completion string. Smaller values indicate
|
|
|
|
* higher-priority (more likely) completions.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned
|
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionPriority(CXCompletionString completion_string);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the availability of the entity that this code-completion
|
|
|
|
* string refers to.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param completion_string The completion string to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns The availability of the completion string.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE enum CXAvailabilityKind
|
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionAvailability(CXCompletionString completion_string);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-14 23:31:08 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the number of annotations associated with the given
|
|
|
|
* completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param completion_string the completion string to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the number of annotations associated with the given completion
|
|
|
|
* string.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned
|
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionNumAnnotations(CXCompletionString completion_string);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the annotation associated with the given completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param completion_string the completion string to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param annotation_number the 0-based index of the annotation of the
|
|
|
|
* completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns annotation string associated with the completion at index
|
|
|
|
* \c annotation_number, or a NULL string if that annotation is not available.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString
|
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionAnnotation(CXCompletionString completion_string,
|
|
|
|
unsigned annotation_number);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-03-28 07:34:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the parent context of the given completion string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The parent context of a completion string is the semantic parent of
|
|
|
|
* the declaration (if any) that the code completion represents. For example,
|
|
|
|
* a code completion for an Objective-C method would have the method's class
|
|
|
|
* or protocol as its context.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param completion_string The code completion string whose parent is
|
|
|
|
* being queried.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param kind If non-NULL, will be set to the kind of the parent context,
|
|
|
|
* or CXCursor_NotImplemented if there is no context.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns The name of the completion parent, e.g., "NSObject" if
|
2012-03-28 07:34:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* the completion string represents a method in the NSObject class.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString
|
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionParent(CXCompletionString completion_string,
|
|
|
|
enum CXCursorKind *kind);
|
2012-07-03 01:35:10 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the brief documentation comment attached to the declaration
|
|
|
|
* that corresponds to the given completion string.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString
|
|
|
|
clang_getCompletionBriefComment(CXCompletionString completion_string);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-08-05 04:04:59 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a completion string for an arbitrary declaration or macro
|
|
|
|
* definition cursor.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param cursor The cursor to query.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns A non-context-sensitive completion string for declaration and macro
|
|
|
|
* definition cursors, or NULL for other kinds of cursors.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXCompletionString
|
|
|
|
clang_getCursorCompletionString(CXCursor cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
2009-12-19 00:20:58 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Contains the results of code-completion.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This data structure contains the results of code completion, as
|
2010-10-12 05:51:20 +08:00
|
|
|
* produced by \c clang_codeCompleteAt(). Its contents must be freed by
|
2009-12-19 00:20:58 +08:00
|
|
|
* \c clang_disposeCodeCompleteResults.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The code-completion results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionResult *Results;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The number of code-completion results stored in the
|
|
|
|
* \c Results array.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
unsigned NumResults;
|
|
|
|
} CXCodeCompleteResults;
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-05 17:09:23 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Flags that can be passed to \c clang_codeCompleteAt() to
|
|
|
|
* modify its behavior.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The enumerators in this enumeration can be bitwise-OR'd together to
|
|
|
|
* provide multiple options to \c clang_codeCompleteAt().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCodeComplete_Flags {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Whether to include macros within the set of code
|
|
|
|
* completions returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCodeComplete_IncludeMacros = 0x01,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Whether to include code patterns for language constructs
|
|
|
|
* within the set of code completions, e.g., for loops.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-07-03 01:35:10 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCodeComplete_IncludeCodePatterns = 0x02,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Whether to include brief documentation within the set of code
|
|
|
|
* completions returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCodeComplete_IncludeBriefComments = 0x04
|
2010-08-05 17:09:23 +08:00
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
2011-07-08 00:03:39 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Bits that represent the context under which completion is occurring.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The enumerators in this enumeration may be bitwise-OR'd together if multiple
|
|
|
|
* contexts are occurring simultaneously.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
enum CXCompletionContext {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The context for completions is unexposed, as only Clang results
|
|
|
|
* should be included. (This is equivalent to having no context bits set.)
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_Unexposed = 0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for any possible type should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_AnyType = 1 << 0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for any possible value (variables, function calls, etc.)
|
|
|
|
* should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_AnyValue = 1 << 1,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for values that resolve to an Objective-C object should
|
|
|
|
* be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCObjectValue = 1 << 2,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for values that resolve to an Objective-C selector
|
|
|
|
* should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCSelectorValue = 1 << 3,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for values that resolve to a C++ class type should be
|
|
|
|
* included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_CXXClassTypeValue = 1 << 4,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for fields of the member being accessed using the dot
|
|
|
|
* operator should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_DotMemberAccess = 1 << 5,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for fields of the member being accessed using the arrow
|
|
|
|
* operator should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ArrowMemberAccess = 1 << 6,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for properties of the Objective-C object being accessed
|
|
|
|
* using the dot operator should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCPropertyAccess = 1 << 7,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for enum tags should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_EnumTag = 1 << 8,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for union tags should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_UnionTag = 1 << 9,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for struct tags should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_StructTag = 1 << 10,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for C++ class names should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ClassTag = 1 << 11,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for C++ namespaces and namespace aliases should be
|
|
|
|
* included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_Namespace = 1 << 12,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for C++ nested name specifiers should be included in
|
|
|
|
* the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_NestedNameSpecifier = 1 << 13,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for Objective-C interfaces (classes) should be included
|
|
|
|
* in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCInterface = 1 << 14,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for Objective-C protocols should be included in
|
|
|
|
* the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCProtocol = 1 << 15,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for Objective-C categories should be included in
|
|
|
|
* the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCCategory = 1 << 16,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for Objective-C instance messages should be included
|
|
|
|
* in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCInstanceMessage = 1 << 17,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for Objective-C class messages should be included in
|
|
|
|
* the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCClassMessage = 1 << 18,
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for Objective-C selector names should be included in
|
|
|
|
* the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_ObjCSelectorName = 1 << 19,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Completions for preprocessor macro names should be included in
|
|
|
|
* the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_MacroName = 1 << 20,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Natural language completions should be included in the results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_NaturalLanguage = 1 << 21,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The current context is unknown, so set all contexts.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXCompletionContext_Unknown = ((1 << 22) - 1)
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-05 17:09:23 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns a default set of code-completion options that can be
|
|
|
|
* passed to\c clang_codeCompleteAt().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_defaultCodeCompleteOptions(void);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-08-05 00:47:14 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Perform code completion at a given location in a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This function performs code completion at a particular file, line, and
|
|
|
|
* column within source code, providing results that suggest potential
|
|
|
|
* code snippets based on the context of the completion. The basic model
|
|
|
|
* for code completion is that Clang will parse a complete source file,
|
|
|
|
* performing syntax checking up to the location where code-completion has
|
|
|
|
* been requested. At that point, a special code-completion token is passed
|
|
|
|
* to the parser, which recognizes this token and determines, based on the
|
|
|
|
* current location in the C/Objective-C/C++ grammar and the state of
|
|
|
|
* semantic analysis, what completions to provide. These completions are
|
|
|
|
* returned via a new \c CXCodeCompleteResults structure.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* Code completion itself is meant to be triggered by the client when the
|
|
|
|
* user types punctuation characters or whitespace, at which point the
|
|
|
|
* code-completion location will coincide with the cursor. For example, if \c p
|
|
|
|
* is a pointer, code-completion might be triggered after the "-" and then
|
|
|
|
* after the ">" in \c p->. When the code-completion location is afer the ">",
|
|
|
|
* the completion results will provide, e.g., the members of the struct that
|
|
|
|
* "p" points to. The client is responsible for placing the cursor at the
|
|
|
|
* beginning of the token currently being typed, then filtering the results
|
|
|
|
* based on the contents of the token. For example, when code-completing for
|
|
|
|
* the expression \c p->get, the client should provide the location just after
|
|
|
|
* the ">" (e.g., pointing at the "g") to this code-completion hook. Then, the
|
|
|
|
* client can filter the results based on the current token text ("get"), only
|
|
|
|
* showing those results that start with "get". The intent of this interface
|
|
|
|
* is to separate the relatively high-latency acquisition of code-completion
|
|
|
|
* results from the filtering of results on a per-character basis, which must
|
|
|
|
* have a lower latency.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param TU The translation unit in which code-completion should
|
|
|
|
* occur. The source files for this translation unit need not be
|
|
|
|
* completely up-to-date (and the contents of those source files may
|
|
|
|
* be overridden via \p unsaved_files). Cursors referring into the
|
|
|
|
* translation unit may be invalidated by this invocation.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param complete_filename The name of the source file where code
|
|
|
|
* completion should be performed. This filename may be any file
|
|
|
|
* included in the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param complete_line The line at which code-completion should occur.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param complete_column The column at which code-completion should occur.
|
|
|
|
* Note that the column should point just after the syntactic construct that
|
|
|
|
* initiated code completion, and not in the middle of a lexical token.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param unsaved_files the Tiles that have not yet been saved to disk
|
|
|
|
* but may be required for parsing or code completion, including the
|
|
|
|
* contents of those files. The contents and name of these files (as
|
|
|
|
* specified by CXUnsavedFile) are copied when necessary, so the
|
|
|
|
* client only needs to guarantee their validity until the call to
|
|
|
|
* this function returns.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param num_unsaved_files The number of unsaved file entries in \p
|
|
|
|
* unsaved_files.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-08-05 17:09:23 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param options Extra options that control the behavior of code
|
|
|
|
* completion, expressed as a bitwise OR of the enumerators of the
|
|
|
|
* CXCodeComplete_Flags enumeration. The
|
|
|
|
* \c clang_defaultCodeCompleteOptions() function returns a default set
|
|
|
|
* of code-completion options.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2010-08-05 00:47:14 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns If successful, a new \c CXCodeCompleteResults structure
|
|
|
|
* containing code-completion results, which should eventually be
|
|
|
|
* freed with \c clang_disposeCodeCompleteResults(). If code
|
|
|
|
* completion fails, returns NULL.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXCodeCompleteResults *clang_codeCompleteAt(CXTranslationUnit TU,
|
|
|
|
const char *complete_filename,
|
|
|
|
unsigned complete_line,
|
|
|
|
unsigned complete_column,
|
|
|
|
struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files,
|
2010-08-05 17:09:23 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned num_unsaved_files,
|
|
|
|
unsigned options);
|
2010-08-05 00:47:14 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-08-26 21:48:20 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Sort the code-completion results in case-insensitive alphabetical
|
|
|
|
* order.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Results The set of results to sort.
|
|
|
|
* \param NumResults The number of results in \p Results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
void clang_sortCodeCompletionResults(CXCompletionResult *Results,
|
|
|
|
unsigned NumResults);
|
|
|
|
|
2009-12-19 00:20:58 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Free the given set of code-completion results.
|
2009-11-07 08:00:49 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
2009-12-19 00:20:58 +08:00
|
|
|
void clang_disposeCodeCompleteResults(CXCodeCompleteResults *Results);
|
2010-08-24 07:00:57 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the number of diagnostics produced prior to the
|
|
|
|
* location where code completion was performed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned clang_codeCompleteGetNumDiagnostics(CXCodeCompleteResults *Results);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a diagnostic associated with the given code completion.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Results the code completion results to query.
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param Index the zero-based diagnostic number to retrieve.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the requested diagnostic. This diagnostic must be freed
|
|
|
|
* via a call to \c clang_disposeDiagnostic().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
2010-02-19 02:08:43 +08:00
|
|
|
CXDiagnostic clang_codeCompleteGetDiagnostic(CXCodeCompleteResults *Results,
|
|
|
|
unsigned Index);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-07-08 00:03:39 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determines what compeltions are appropriate for the context
|
|
|
|
* the given code completion.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Results the code completion results to query
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the kinds of completions that are appropriate for use
|
|
|
|
* along with the given code completion results.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
unsigned long long clang_codeCompleteGetContexts(
|
|
|
|
CXCodeCompleteResults *Results);
|
2011-07-21 09:05:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the cursor kind for the container for the current code
|
|
|
|
* completion context. The container is only guaranteed to be set for
|
|
|
|
* contexts where a container exists (i.e. member accesses or Objective-C
|
|
|
|
* message sends); if there is not a container, this function will return
|
|
|
|
* CXCursor_InvalidCode.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Results the code completion results to query
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param IsIncomplete on return, this value will be false if Clang has complete
|
|
|
|
* information about the container. If Clang does not have complete
|
|
|
|
* information, this value will be true.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the container kind, or CXCursor_InvalidCode if there is not a
|
|
|
|
* container
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
enum CXCursorKind clang_codeCompleteGetContainerKind(
|
|
|
|
CXCodeCompleteResults *Results,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *IsIncomplete);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the USR for the container for the current code completion
|
|
|
|
* context. If there is not a container for the current context, this
|
|
|
|
* function will return the empty string.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Results the code completion results to query
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the USR for the container
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_codeCompleteGetContainerUSR(CXCodeCompleteResults *Results);
|
2011-07-08 00:03:39 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-07-26 23:24:30 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Returns the currently-entered selector for an Objective-C message
|
|
|
|
* send, formatted like "initWithFoo:bar:". Only guaranteed to return a
|
|
|
|
* non-empty string for CXCompletionContext_ObjCInstanceMessage and
|
|
|
|
* CXCompletionContext_ObjCClassMessage.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param Results the code completion results to query
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the selector (or partial selector) that has been entered thus far
|
|
|
|
* for an Objective-C message send.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXString clang_codeCompleteGetObjCSelector(CXCodeCompleteResults *Results);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-20 09:10:47 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:44:15 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \defgroup CINDEX_MISC Miscellaneous utility functions
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 01:51:23 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Return a version string, suitable for showing to a user, but not
|
|
|
|
* intended to be parsed (the format is not guaranteed to be stable).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-02-13 06:54:40 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXString clang_getClangVersion();
|
2010-01-23 06:44:15 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-03-19 07:05:39 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Enable/disable crash recovery.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param isEnabled Flag to indicate if crash recovery is enabled. A non-zero
|
|
|
|
* value enables crash recovery, while 0 disables it.
|
2011-03-19 07:05:39 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_toggleCrashRecovery(unsigned isEnabled);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-27 03:31:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2010-03-13 10:50:34 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Visitor invoked for each file in a translation unit
|
2010-01-27 03:31:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* (used with clang_getInclusions()).
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* This visitor function will be invoked by clang_getInclusions() for each
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* file included (either at the top-level or by \#include directives) within
|
2010-01-27 03:31:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* a translation unit. The first argument is the file being included, and
|
|
|
|
* the second and third arguments provide the inclusion stack. The
|
|
|
|
* array is sorted in order of immediate inclusion. For example,
|
|
|
|
* the first element refers to the location that included 'included_file'.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void (*CXInclusionVisitor)(CXFile included_file,
|
|
|
|
CXSourceLocation* inclusion_stack,
|
|
|
|
unsigned include_len,
|
|
|
|
CXClientData client_data);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Visit the set of preprocessor inclusions in a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
* The visitor function is called with the provided data for every included
|
|
|
|
* file. This does not include headers included by the PCH file (unless one
|
|
|
|
* is inspecting the inclusions in the PCH file itself).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_getInclusions(CXTranslationUnit tu,
|
|
|
|
CXInclusionVisitor visitor,
|
|
|
|
CXClientData client_data);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-07-12 04:15:00 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \defgroup CINDEX_REMAPPING Remapping functions
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A remapping of original source files and their translated files.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void *CXRemapping;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a remapping.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param path the path that contains metadata about remappings.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the requested remapping. This remapping must be freed
|
|
|
|
* via a call to \c clang_remap_dispose(). Can return NULL if an error occurred.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXRemapping clang_getRemappings(const char *path);
|
|
|
|
|
2012-03-07 04:06:33 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve a remapping.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param filePaths pointer to an array of file paths containing remapping info.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param numFiles number of file paths.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns the requested remapping. This remapping must be freed
|
|
|
|
* via a call to \c clang_remap_dispose(). Can return NULL if an error occurred.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXRemapping clang_getRemappingsFromFileList(const char **filePaths,
|
|
|
|
unsigned numFiles);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-07-12 04:15:00 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Determine the number of remappings.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE unsigned clang_remap_getNumFiles(CXRemapping);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Get the original and the associated filename from the remapping.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param original If non-NULL, will be set to the original filename.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param transformed If non-NULL, will be set to the filename that the original
|
|
|
|
* is associated with.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_remap_getFilenames(CXRemapping, unsigned index,
|
|
|
|
CXString *original, CXString *transformed);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Dispose the remapping.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_remap_dispose(CXRemapping);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-06 15:00:54 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/** \defgroup CINDEX_HIGH Higher level API functions
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* @{
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
enum CXVisitorResult {
|
|
|
|
CXVisit_Break,
|
|
|
|
CXVisit_Continue
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
void *context;
|
|
|
|
enum CXVisitorResult (*visit)(void *context, CXCursor, CXSourceRange);
|
|
|
|
} CXCursorAndRangeVisitor;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Find references of a declaration in a specific file.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param cursor pointing to a declaration or a reference of one.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param file to search for references.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param visitor callback that will receive pairs of CXCursor/CXSourceRange for
|
|
|
|
* each reference found.
|
|
|
|
* The CXSourceRange will point inside the file; if the reference is inside
|
|
|
|
* a macro (and not a macro argument) the CXSourceRange will be invalid.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_findReferencesInFile(CXCursor cursor, CXFile file,
|
|
|
|
CXCursorAndRangeVisitor visitor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __has_feature
|
|
|
|
# if __has_feature(blocks)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef enum CXVisitorResult
|
|
|
|
(^CXCursorAndRangeVisitorBlock)(CXCursor, CXSourceRange);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
void clang_findReferencesInFileWithBlock(CXCursor, CXFile,
|
|
|
|
CXCursorAndRangeVisitorBlock);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
# endif
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The client's data object that is associated with a CXFile.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef void *CXIdxClientFile;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The client's data object that is associated with a semantic entity.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void *CXIdxClientEntity;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The client's data object that is associated with a semantic container
|
|
|
|
* of entities.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef void *CXIdxClientContainer;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The client's data object that is associated with an AST file (PCH
|
|
|
|
* or module).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef void *CXIdxClientASTFile;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Source location passed to index callbacks.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
void *ptr_data[2];
|
|
|
|
unsigned int_data;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxLoc;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Data for ppIncludedFile callback.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Location of '#' in the \#include/\#import directive.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc hashLoc;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Filename as written in the \#include/\#import directive.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
const char *filename;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief The actual file that the \#include/\#import directive resolved to.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXFile file;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
int isImport;
|
|
|
|
int isAngled;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxIncludedFileInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Data for IndexerCallbacks#importedASTFile.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
CXFile file;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Location where the file is imported. It is useful mostly for
|
|
|
|
* modules.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc loc;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Non-zero if the AST file is a module otherwise it's a PCH.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
int isModule;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxImportedASTFileInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef enum {
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Unexposed = 0,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Typedef = 1,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Function = 2,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Variable = 3,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Field = 4,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_EnumConstant = 5,
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_ObjCClass = 6,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_ObjCProtocol = 7,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_ObjCCategory = 8,
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-15 06:39:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_ObjCInstanceMethod = 9,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_ObjCClassMethod = 10,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_ObjCProperty = 11,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_ObjCIvar = 12,
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-15 06:39:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Enum = 13,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Struct = 14,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Union = 15,
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXClass = 16,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXNamespace = 17,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXNamespaceAlias = 18,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXStaticVariable = 19,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXStaticMethod = 20,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXInstanceMethod = 21,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXConstructor = 22,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXDestructor = 23,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXConversionFunction = 24,
|
2011-12-08 04:44:12 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_CXXTypeAlias = 25
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXIdxEntityKind;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-12-08 04:44:12 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef enum {
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityLang_None = 0,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityLang_C = 1,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityLang_ObjC = 2,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityLang_CXX = 3
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxEntityLanguage;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Extra C++ template information for an entity. This can apply to:
|
|
|
|
* CXIdxEntity_Function
|
|
|
|
* CXIdxEntity_CXXClass
|
|
|
|
* CXIdxEntity_CXXStaticMethod
|
|
|
|
* CXIdxEntity_CXXInstanceMethod
|
|
|
|
* CXIdxEntity_CXXConstructor
|
|
|
|
* CXIdxEntity_CXXConversionFunction
|
|
|
|
* CXIdxEntity_CXXTypeAlias
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef enum {
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_NonTemplate = 0,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_Template = 1,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_TemplatePartialSpecialization = 2,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntity_TemplateSpecialization = 3
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxEntityCXXTemplateKind;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-18 08:26:51 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef enum {
|
|
|
|
CXIdxAttr_Unexposed = 0,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxAttr_IBAction = 1,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxAttr_IBOutlet = 2,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxAttr_IBOutletCollection = 3
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxAttrKind;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
CXIdxAttrKind kind;
|
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor;
|
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc loc;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxAttrInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-12-15 08:05:00 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityKind kind;
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityCXXTemplateKind templateKind;
|
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityLanguage lang;
|
|
|
|
const char *name;
|
|
|
|
const char *USR;
|
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxAttrInfo *const *attributes;
|
|
|
|
unsigned numAttributes;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxEntityInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxContainerInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-18 08:26:51 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxAttrInfo *attrInfo;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *objcClass;
|
|
|
|
CXCursor classCursor;
|
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc classLoc;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxIBOutletCollectionAttrInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *entityInfo;
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor;
|
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc loc;
|
2011-12-08 04:44:19 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxContainerInfo *semanticContainer;
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Generally same as #semanticContainer but can be different in
|
2011-12-08 04:44:19 +08:00
|
|
|
* cases like out-of-line C++ member functions.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxContainerInfo *lexicalContainer;
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
int isRedeclaration;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
int isDefinition;
|
2011-11-15 06:39:19 +08:00
|
|
|
int isContainer;
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxContainerInfo *declAsContainer;
|
2011-11-15 06:39:19 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Whether the declaration exists in code or was created implicitly
|
|
|
|
* by the compiler, e.g. implicit objc methods for properties.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int isImplicit;
|
2011-11-18 08:26:51 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxAttrInfo *const *attributes;
|
|
|
|
unsigned numAttributes;
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXIdxDeclInfo;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef enum {
|
|
|
|
CXIdxObjCContainer_ForwardRef = 0,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxObjCContainer_Interface = 1,
|
|
|
|
CXIdxObjCContainer_Implementation = 2
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxObjCContainerKind;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxDeclInfo *declInfo;
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxObjCContainerKind kind;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxObjCContainerDeclInfo;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *base;
|
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc loc;
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXIdxBaseClassInfo;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *protocol;
|
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc loc;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxObjCProtocolRefInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxObjCProtocolRefInfo *const *protocols;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned numProtocols;
|
2011-11-15 06:39:19 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXIdxObjCProtocolRefListInfo;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-11-15 06:39:19 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxObjCContainerDeclInfo *containerInfo;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxBaseClassInfo *superInfo;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxObjCProtocolRefListInfo *protocols;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxObjCInterfaceDeclInfo;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-12-14 02:47:45 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxObjCContainerDeclInfo *containerInfo;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *objcClass;
|
|
|
|
CXCursor classCursor;
|
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc classLoc;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxObjCProtocolRefListInfo *protocols;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxObjCCategoryDeclInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2012-02-29 01:50:33 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxDeclInfo *declInfo;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *getter;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *setter;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxObjCPropertyDeclInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxDeclInfo *declInfo;
|
|
|
|
const CXIdxBaseClassInfo *const *bases;
|
|
|
|
unsigned numBases;
|
|
|
|
} CXIdxCXXClassDeclInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Data for IndexerCallbacks#indexEntityReference.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 23:50:50 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef enum {
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The entity is referenced directly in user's code.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 23:50:50 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityRef_Direct = 1,
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2011-11-18 08:26:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief An implicit reference, e.g. a reference of an ObjC method via the
|
|
|
|
* dot syntax.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-18 08:26:51 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityRef_Implicit = 2
|
2011-10-18 23:50:50 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXIdxEntityRefKind;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Data for IndexerCallbacks#indexEntityReference.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-12-08 04:44:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxEntityRefKind kind;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Reference cursor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXCursor cursor;
|
|
|
|
CXIdxLoc loc;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief The entity that gets referenced.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *referencedEntity;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Immediate "parent" of the reference. For example:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \code
|
|
|
|
* Foo *var;
|
|
|
|
* \endcode
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The parent of reference of type 'Foo' is the variable 'var'.
|
2011-12-14 02:47:41 +08:00
|
|
|
* For references inside statement bodies of functions/methods,
|
|
|
|
* the parentEntity will be the function/method.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityInfo *parentEntity;
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2011-12-14 02:47:41 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Lexical container context of the reference.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxContainerInfo *container;
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXIdxEntityRefInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief A group of callbacks used by #clang_indexSourceFile and
|
|
|
|
* #clang_indexTranslationUnit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef struct {
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Called periodically to check whether indexing should be aborted.
|
|
|
|
* Should return 0 to continue, and non-zero to abort.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int (*abortQuery)(CXClientData client_data, void *reserved);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2011-11-18 08:26:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Called at the end of indexing; passes the complete diagnostic set.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
void (*diagnostic)(CXClientData client_data,
|
2011-11-18 08:26:51 +08:00
|
|
|
CXDiagnosticSet, void *reserved);
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxClientFile (*enteredMainFile)(CXClientData client_data,
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
CXFile mainFile, void *reserved);
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Called when a file gets \#included/\#imported.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxClientFile (*ppIncludedFile)(CXClientData client_data,
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxIncludedFileInfo *);
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Called when a AST file (PCH or module) gets imported.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* AST files will not get indexed (there will not be callbacks to index all
|
|
|
|
* the entities in an AST file). The recommended action is that, if the AST
|
|
|
|
* file is not already indexed, to block further indexing and initiate a new
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
* indexing job specific to the AST file.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxClientASTFile (*importedASTFile)(CXClientData client_data,
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxImportedASTFileInfo *);
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Called at the beginning of indexing a translation unit.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxClientContainer (*startedTranslationUnit)(CXClientData client_data,
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
void *reserved);
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
void (*indexDeclaration)(CXClientData client_data,
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxDeclInfo *);
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Called to index a reference of an entity.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
void (*indexEntityReference)(CXClientData client_data,
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxEntityRefInfo *);
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
} IndexerCallbacks;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-11 10:51:09 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_index_isEntityObjCContainerKind(CXIdxEntityKind);
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE const CXIdxObjCContainerDeclInfo *
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getObjCContainerDeclInfo(const CXIdxDeclInfo *);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE const CXIdxObjCInterfaceDeclInfo *
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getObjCInterfaceDeclInfo(const CXIdxDeclInfo *);
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-11-11 10:51:09 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
2011-11-12 10:16:30 +08:00
|
|
|
const CXIdxObjCCategoryDeclInfo *
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getObjCCategoryDeclInfo(const CXIdxDeclInfo *);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-15 06:39:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE const CXIdxObjCProtocolRefListInfo *
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getObjCProtocolRefListInfo(const CXIdxDeclInfo *);
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2012-02-29 01:50:33 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE const CXIdxObjCPropertyDeclInfo *
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getObjCPropertyDeclInfo(const CXIdxDeclInfo *);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-18 08:26:51 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE const CXIdxIBOutletCollectionAttrInfo *
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getIBOutletCollectionAttrInfo(const CXIdxAttrInfo *);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE const CXIdxCXXClassDeclInfo *
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getCXXClassDeclInfo(const CXIdxDeclInfo *);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief For retrieving a custom CXIdxClientContainer attached to a
|
|
|
|
* container.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXIdxClientContainer
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getClientContainer(const CXIdxContainerInfo *);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief For setting a custom CXIdxClientContainer attached to a
|
|
|
|
* container.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void
|
|
|
|
clang_index_setClientContainer(const CXIdxContainerInfo *,CXIdxClientContainer);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief For retrieving a custom CXIdxClientEntity attached to an entity.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXIdxClientEntity
|
|
|
|
clang_index_getClientEntity(const CXIdxEntityInfo *);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief For setting a custom CXIdxClientEntity attached to an entity.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void
|
|
|
|
clang_index_setClientEntity(const CXIdxEntityInfo *, CXIdxClientEntity);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An indexing action, to be applied to one or multiple translation units
|
|
|
|
* but not on concurrent threads. If there are threads doing indexing
|
|
|
|
* concurrently, they should use different CXIndexAction objects.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
typedef void *CXIndexAction;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief An indexing action, to be applied to one or multiple translation units
|
|
|
|
* but not on concurrent threads. If there are threads doing indexing
|
|
|
|
* concurrently, they should use different CXIndexAction objects.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param CIdx The index object with which the index action will be associated.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE CXIndexAction clang_IndexAction_create(CXIndex CIdx);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Destroy the given index action.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The index action must not be destroyed until all of the translation units
|
|
|
|
* created within that index action have been destroyed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_IndexAction_dispose(CXIndexAction);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
typedef enum {
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that no special indexing options are needed.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXIndexOpt_None = 0x0,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \brief Used to indicate that IndexerCallbacks#indexEntityReference should
|
|
|
|
* be invoked for only one reference of an entity per source file that does
|
|
|
|
* not also include a declaration/definition of the entity.
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-01-14 08:11:49 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIndexOpt_SuppressRedundantRefs = 0x1,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Function-local symbols should be indexed. If this is not set
|
|
|
|
* function-local symbols will be ignored.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-02-15 06:23:11 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIndexOpt_IndexFunctionLocalSymbols = 0x2,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Implicit function/class template instantiations should be indexed.
|
|
|
|
* If this is not set, implicit instantiations will be ignored.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2012-03-28 05:38:03 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIndexOpt_IndexImplicitTemplateInstantiations = 0x4,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Suppress all compiler warnings when parsing for indexing.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
CXIndexOpt_SuppressWarnings = 0x8
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
} CXIndexOptFlags;
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Index the given source file and the translation unit corresponding
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* to that file via callbacks implemented through #IndexerCallbacks.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param client_data pointer data supplied by the client, which will
|
|
|
|
* be passed to the invoked callbacks.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param index_callbacks Pointer to indexing callbacks that the client
|
|
|
|
* implements.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param index_callbacks_size Size of #IndexerCallbacks structure that gets
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
* passed in index_callbacks.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* \param index_options A bitmask of options that affects how indexing is
|
|
|
|
* performed. This should be a bitwise OR of the CXIndexOpt_XXX flags.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \param out_TU [out] pointer to store a CXTranslationUnit that can be reused
|
|
|
|
* after indexing is finished. Set to NULL if you do not require it.
|
|
|
|
*
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
* \returns If there is a failure from which the there is no recovery, returns
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
* non-zero, otherwise returns 0.
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* The rest of the parameters are the same as #clang_parseTranslationUnit.
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_indexSourceFile(CXIndexAction,
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXClientData client_data,
|
|
|
|
IndexerCallbacks *index_callbacks,
|
|
|
|
unsigned index_callbacks_size,
|
|
|
|
unsigned index_options,
|
|
|
|
const char *source_filename,
|
|
|
|
const char * const *command_line_args,
|
|
|
|
int num_command_line_args,
|
|
|
|
struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files,
|
|
|
|
unsigned num_unsaved_files,
|
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit *out_TU,
|
|
|
|
unsigned TU_options);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Index the given translation unit via callbacks implemented through
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* #IndexerCallbacks.
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* The order of callback invocations is not guaranteed to be the same as
|
|
|
|
* when indexing a source file. The high level order will be:
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* -Preprocessor callbacks invocations
|
|
|
|
* -Declaration/reference callbacks invocations
|
|
|
|
* -Diagnostic callback invocations
|
|
|
|
*
|
2012-06-15 13:41:51 +08:00
|
|
|
* The parameters are the same as #clang_indexSourceFile.
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* \returns If there is a failure from which the there is no recovery, returns
|
|
|
|
* non-zero, otherwise returns 0.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE int clang_indexTranslationUnit(CXIndexAction,
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
CXClientData client_data,
|
|
|
|
IndexerCallbacks *index_callbacks,
|
|
|
|
unsigned index_callbacks_size,
|
2011-11-22 15:24:51 +08:00
|
|
|
unsigned index_options,
|
|
|
|
CXTranslationUnit);
|
2011-11-15 14:20:16 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the CXIdxFile, file, line, column, and offset represented by
|
|
|
|
* the given CXIdxLoc.
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
* If the location refers into a macro expansion, retrieves the
|
|
|
|
* location of the macro expansion and if it refers into a macro argument
|
|
|
|
* retrieves the location of the argument.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE void clang_indexLoc_getFileLocation(CXIdxLoc loc,
|
2011-11-11 08:23:36 +08:00
|
|
|
CXIdxClientFile *indexFile,
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CXFile *file,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *line,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *column,
|
|
|
|
unsigned *offset);
|
|
|
|
|
2011-10-28 01:36:12 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* \brief Retrieve the CXSourceLocation represented by the given CXIdxLoc.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2011-10-18 03:48:19 +08:00
|
|
|
CINDEX_LINKAGE
|
|
|
|
CXSourceLocation clang_indexLoc_getCXSourceLocation(CXIdxLoc loc);
|
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:44:15 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2010-01-23 06:29:16 +08:00
|
|
|
/**
|
|
|
|
* @}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
2010-01-24 10:54:26 +08:00
|
|
|
|
2009-08-27 06:36:44 +08:00
|
|
|
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|